11773 lines
		
	
	
		
			372 KiB
		
	
	
	
		
			TeX
		
	
	
	
	
	
		
		
			
		
	
	
			11773 lines
		
	
	
		
			372 KiB
		
	
	
	
		
			TeX
		
	
	
	
	
	
| 
								 | 
							
								% texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\texinfoversion{2020-10-24.12}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Copyright 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% License, or (at your option) any later version.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% General Public License for more details.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% along with this program.  If not, see <https://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% restriction. This Exception is an additional permission under section 7
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% of the GNU General Public License, version 3 ("GPLv3").
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% reports; you can get the latest version from:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/ (the Texinfo release area), or
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   https://ftpmirror.gnu.org/texinfo/ (same, via a mirror), or
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   https://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org.  Please include a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% problem.  Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution.  For a simple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   tex foo.texi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   texindex foo.??
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   tex foo.texi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   tex foo.texi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   dvips foo.dvi -o  # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% extent.  You can get the existing language-specific files from the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% full Texinfo distribution.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The GNU Texinfo home page is https://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If in a .fmt file, print the version number
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% they might have appeared in the input file name.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% LaTeX's \typeout.  This ensures that the messages it is used for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% are identical in format to the corresponding ones from latex/pdflatex.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\typeout{\immediate\write17}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\chardef\other=12
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\+ = \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexb=\b
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexbullet=\bullet
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexc=\c
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexcomma=\,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexdot=\.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexdots=\dots
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexend=\end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexequiv=\equiv
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexexclam=\!
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexgtr=>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexhat=^
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexi=\i
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexindent=\indent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexinsert=\insert
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexlbrace=\{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexless=<
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexplus=+
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexraggedright=\raggedright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexrbrace=\}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexslash=\/
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexsp=\sp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexstar=\*
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptexsup=\sup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptext=\t
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ptextop=\top
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\catcode`\'=\active \global\let\ptexquoteright'}% active in plain's math mode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% starts a new line in the output.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newlinechar = `^^J
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined  \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordChapter\undefined   \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putworderror\undefined     \gdef\putworderror{error}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordfile\undefined      \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordin\undefined        \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined       \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined   \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordInfo\undefined      \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined  \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined   \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordof\undefined        \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordon\undefined        \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordpage\undefined      \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordsection\undefined   \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordSection\undefined   \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordsee\undefined       \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordSee\undefined       \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined  \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordTOC\undefined       \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined    \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined   \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined    \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined    \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined   \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Give the space character the catcode for a space.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =10\relax}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Likewise for ^^M, the end of line character.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\endlineisspace{\catcode13=10\relax}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\chardef\dashChar  = `\-
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\chardef\slashChar = `\/
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\chardef\underChar = `\_
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Ignore a token.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\gobble#1{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The following is used inside several \edef's.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Hyphenation fixes.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\hyphenation{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  spell-ing spell-ings
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  wide-spread wrap-around
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and nothing on the terminal.  We don't just call \tracingall here,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% since that produces some useless output on the terminal.  We also make
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\loggingall{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tracingstats2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tracingpages1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tracinglostchars2  % 2 gives us more in etex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tracingparagraphs1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tracingoutput1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tracingmacros2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tracingrestores1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined\else % etex gives us more logging
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \tracingscantokens1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \tracingifs1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \tracinggroups1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \tracingnesting2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \tracingassigns1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tracingcommands3  % 3 gives us more in etex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \errorcontextlines16
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @errormsg{MSG}.  Do the index-like expansions on MSG, but if things
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% aren't perfect, it's not the end of the world, being an error message,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% after all.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\errormsg{\begingroup \indexnofonts \doerrormsg}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doerrormsg#1{\errmessage{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions.  If the last thing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Output routine
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For a final copy, take out the rectangles
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% of a page, or that at the bottom of a page.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \domark is called twice inside \chapmacro, to add one
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% mark before the section break, and one after.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   In the second call \prevchapterdefs is the same as \currentchapterdefs,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and \prevsectiondefs is the same as \currentsectiondefs.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   Then if the page is not broken at the mark, some of the previous
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% section appears on the page, and we can get the name of this section
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% from \firstmark for @everyheadingmarks top.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   @everyheadingmarks bottom uses \botmark.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% See page 260 of The TeXbook.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\domark{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \toks0=\expandafter{\currentchapterdefs}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \toks2=\expandafter{\currentsectiondefs}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \toks8=\expandafter{\currentcolordefs}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \mark{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                   \the\toks0 \the\toks2  % 0: marks for @everyheadingmarks top
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6  % 1: for @everyheadingmarks bottom
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \noexpand\else \the\toks8             % 2: color marks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \gettopheadingmarks, \getbottomheadingmarks,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \getcolormarks - extract needed part of mark.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% first @chapter.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\gettopheadingmarks{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifcase0\the\savedtopmark\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\the\savedtopmark\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\currentchapterdefs{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\currentsectiondefs{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\currentsection{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\prevchapterdefs{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\prevsectiondefs{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\currentcolordefs{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\bindingoffset
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\normaloffset
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\txipagewidth \newdimen\txipageheight
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Main output routine.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\chardef\PAGE = 255
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newtoks\defaultoutput
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\defaultoutput = {\savetopmark\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\output=\expandafter{\the\defaultoutput}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newbox\headlinebox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newbox\footlinebox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% When outputting the double column layout for indices, an output routine
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% is run several times, which hides the original value of \topmark.  This
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% can lead to a page heading being output and duplicating the chapter heading
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% of the index.  Hence, save the contents of \topmark at the beginning of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the output routine.  The saved contents are valid until we actually
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \shipout a page.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (We used to run a short output routine to actually set \topmark and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \firstmark to the right values, but if this was called with an empty page
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% containing whatsits for writing index entries, the whatsits would be thrown
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% away and the index auxiliary file would remain empty.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newtoks\savedtopmark
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\iftopmarksaved
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\topmarksavedtrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\savetopmark{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \iftopmarksaved\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\savedtopmark=\expandafter{\topmark}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\topmarksavedtrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \shipout a vbox for a single page, adding an optional header, footer
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and footnote.  This also causes index entries for this page to be written
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% to the auxiliary files.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\onepageout#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hoffset=\normaloffset
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifodd\pageno  \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \checkchapterpage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Retrieve the information for the headings from the marks in the page,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % and call Plain TeX's \makeheadline and \makefootline, which use the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % values in \headline and \footline.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Common context changes for both heading and footing.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\commonheadfootline{\let\hsize=\txipagewidth \texinfochars}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\commonheadfootline \makeheadline}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\commonheadfootline \makefootline}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Set context for writing to auxiliary files like index files.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % before the \shipout runs.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \atdummies         % don't expand commands in the output.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \turnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \shipout\vbox{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \unvbox\headlinebox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \pagebody{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \vskip 24pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \unvbox\footlinebox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\topmarksavedfalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advancepageno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Main part of page, including any footnotes
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\txipageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\catcode`\@ =11
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\dimen@=\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Check if we are on the first page of a chapter.  Used for printing headings.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifchapterpage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\checkchapterpage{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Get the chapter that was current at the end of the last page
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifcase1\the\savedtopmark\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\prevchaptername\thischaptername
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\curchaptername\thischaptername
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\curchaptername\prevchaptername
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \chapterpagefalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \chapterpagetrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Argument parsing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Parse an argument, then pass it to #1.  The argument is the rest of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the input line (except we remove a trailing comment).  #1 should be a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For example, \def\foo{\parsearg\fooxxx}.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\parseargusing#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\argtorun{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \obeylines
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \spaceisspace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    #1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\obeylines %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.  Pass the result on to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \argcheckspaces.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%    @end itemize  @c foo
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% by \finishparsearg.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\temp\finishparsearg
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\temp\argcheckspaces
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Put the space token in:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% just before passing the control to \argtorun.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% that a pair of braces would be stripped.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \parseargdef - define a command taking an argument on the line
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \parseargdef\foo{...}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%	is roughly equivalent to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \def\Xfoo#1{...}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\parseargdef#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def#1##1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Several utility definitions with active space:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \obeyspaces
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % space in the output.  Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % should produce a line of output anyway.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex.  It's used like this:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   \envdef\foo{...}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   \def\Efoo{...}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo.  \envdef also
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% whether the environment name matches.  The \checkenv macro can also be
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% are not treated as environments; they don't open a group.  (The
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% special case.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% At run-time, environments start with this:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% initialize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\thisenv\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Check whether we're in the right environment:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\checkenv#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\thisenv\temp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \badenverr
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Environment mismatch, #1 expected:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\badenverr{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \errhelp = \EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\inenvironment#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx#1\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    outside of any environment%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    in environment \expandafter\string#1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\end{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \csname E#1\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\catcode`@ = 11
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								 % if the definition is written into an index file.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @: forces normal size whitespace following.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @* forces a line break.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\*{\unskip\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @/ allows a line break.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\/=\allowbreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @. is an end-of-sentence period.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @? is an end-of-sentence query.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @frenchspacing on|off  says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\onword{on}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\offword{off}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errhelp = \EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on|off}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @w prevents a word break.  Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% it in a TeX vbox.  We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% to keep its height that of a normal line.  According to the rules for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0).  If that height is large,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the text is small, which looks bad.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Another complication is that the group might be very large.  This can
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% does not have much material.  In this case, it's better to add an
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom.  The
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newbox\groupbox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\vfilllimit{0.7}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\group{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \startsavinginserts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % end-of-line in the output.  We don't want the end-of-line after
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % the `@group' to put extra space in the output.  Since @group
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \comment
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \lineskip glue after it.  Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% above.  But it's pretty close.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Egroup{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \egroup           % End the \vtop.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \addgroupbox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \prevdepth = \dimen1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \checkinserts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\addgroupbox{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox  \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dimen2 = \txipageheight   \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % group, force a page break.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\txipageheight
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \page
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \box\groupbox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								where each line of input produces a line of output.}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @need space-in-mils
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\mil  \mil=0.001in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\need{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % paragraph.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \par
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dimen0 = #1\mil
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % And a page break here is fine.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % main vertical list is 10000 or more.  But in order to see if the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % page breaks.  On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % page after the empty box.  So we use a penalty of 9999.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % sight.  (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % good page breaking, for example.)  However, I could not construct an
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \penalty9999
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \kern -#1\mil
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nobreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @br   forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\br = \par
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @page forces the start of a new page.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @exdent text....
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% That's how much \exdent should take out.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\exdentamount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% paragraph.  For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% class.  WHICH is `l' or `r'.  Not documented, written for gawk manual.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nobreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \kern-\strutdepth
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vtop to \strutdepth{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \baselineskip=\strutdepth
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \vss
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx#1l%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \null
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% else use TEXT for both).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\lefttext{#1}%  have both texts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\righttext{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\lefttext{#1}%  have only one text
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\righttext{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifodd\pageno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \temp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @include FILE -- \input text of FILE.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\includezzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \pushthisfilestack
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\thisfile{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \makevalueexpandable  % we want to expand any @value in FILE.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \turnoffactive        % and allow special characters in the expansion
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \indexnofonts         % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @include of #1^^J}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % definitions, etc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }\temp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \popthisfilestack
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\filenamecatcodes{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\\=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`~=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`^=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`_=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`|=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`<=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`>=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`+=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`-=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\`=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\'=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\pushthisfilestack{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\pushthisfilestackX{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  the stack of filenames is empty.}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\thisfile{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @center line
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% outputs that line, centered.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\center{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifhmode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\centersub\centerH
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\centersub\centerV
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \centersub{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\centersub\relax % don't let the definition persist, just in case
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\centerH#1{{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hfil\break
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \line{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \break
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\centerpenalty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\centerV#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % The idea here is the same as in \startdefun, \cartouche, etc.: if
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % @center is the first thing after a section heading, we need to wipe
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % out the negative parskip inserted by \sectionheading, but still
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % prevent a page break here.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \centerpenalty = \lastpenalty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\centerpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\centerpenalty>9999 \penalty\centerpenalty \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @sp n   outputs n lines of vertical space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @comment ...line which is ignored...
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @c is the same as @comment
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @ignore ... @end ignore  is another way to write a comment
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\c{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\active%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\cxxx}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\catcode`\^^M=\active \gdef\cxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\comment\c
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @paragraphindent NCHARS
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\noneword{none}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\asisword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\temp\noneword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \defaultparindent = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \defaultparindent = #1em
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parindent = \defaultparindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @exampleindent NCHARS
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\exampleindent{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\asisword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\temp\noneword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \lispnarrowing = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \lispnarrowing = #1em
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @firstparagraphindent WORD
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% after a section heading.  If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% paragraphs.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% By default, we suppress indentation.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\insertword{insert}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\noneword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\temp\insertword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errhelp = \EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Here is how we actually suppress indentation.  Redefine \everypar to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% paragraph.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\indent  {\restorefirstparagraphindent \indent}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\noindent{\restorefirstparagraphindent \noindent}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\everypar = {\kern -\parindent \restorefirstparagraphindent}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let\indent = \ptexindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let\noindent = \ptexnoindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\everypar = {}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @refill is a no-op.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\refill=\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @setfilename INFO-FILENAME - ignored
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\setfilename=\comment
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @bye.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\outer\def\bye{\chappager\pagelabels\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{pdf,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% adobe `portable' document format
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\tempnum
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\lnkcount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newtoks\filename
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\filenamelength
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\pgn
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newtoks\toksA
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newtoks\toksB
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newtoks\toksC
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newtoks\toksD
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newbox\boxA
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newbox\boxB
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\countA
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifpdf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For LuaTeX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\iftxiuseunicodedestname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\txiuseunicodedestnamefalse % For pdfTeX etc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Use Unicode destination names
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \txiuseunicodedestnametrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Escape PDF strings with converting UTF-16 from UTF-8
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \catcode`\%=12
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \directlua{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      function UTF16oct(str)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        tex.sprint(string.char(0x5c) .. '376' .. string.char(0x5c) .. '377')
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        for c in string.utfvalues(str) do
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if c < 0x10000 then
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            tex.sprint(
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              string.format(string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                            string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o',
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                            math.floor(c / 256), math.floor(c % 256)))
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            c = c - 0x10000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            local c_hi = c / 1024 + 0xd800
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            local c_lo = c % 1024 + 0xdc00
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            tex.sprint(
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              string.format(string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                            string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                            string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                            string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o',
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                            math.floor(c_hi / 256), math.floor(c_hi % 256),
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                            math.floor(c_lo / 256), math.floor(c_lo % 256)))
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdfescapestrutfsixteen#1{\directlua{UTF16oct('\luaescapestring{#1}')}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Escape PDF strings without converting
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \directlua{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      function PDFescstr(str)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        for c in string.bytes(str) do
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          if c <= 0x20 or c >= 0x80 or c == 0x28 or c == 0x29 or c == 0x5c then
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            tex.sprint(-2,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              string.format(string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o',
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                            c))
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            tex.sprint(-2, string.char(c))
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % The -2 in the arguments here gives all the input to TeX catcode 12
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % (other) or 10 (space), preventing undefined control sequence errors. See
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-texinfo/2019-08/msg00031.html
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdfescapestring#1{\directlua{PDFescstr('\luaescapestring{#1}')}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\luatexversion>84
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % For LuaTeX >= 0.85
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\pdfdest{\pdfextension dest}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\pdfoutput\outputmode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\pdfliteral{\pdfextension literal}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\pdfcatalog{\pdfextension catalog}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\pdftexversion{\numexpr\pdffeedback version\relax}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\pdfximage\saveimageresource
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\pdfrefximage\useimageresource
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\pdflastximage\lastsavedimageresourceindex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\pdfendlink{\pdfextension endlink\relax}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\pdfoutline{\pdfextension outline}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\pdfstartlink{\pdfextension startlink}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\pdffontattr{\pdfextension fontattr}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\pdfobj{\pdfextension obj}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\pdflastobj{\numexpr\pdffeedback lastobj\relax}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\pdfpagewidth\pagewidth
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\pdfpageheight\pageheight
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \edef\pdfhorigin{\pdfvariable horigin}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \edef\pdfvorigin{\pdfvariable vorigin}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% can be set).  So we test for \relax and 0 as well as being undefined.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\pdfoutput\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifcase\pdfoutput
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \pdftrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifpdforxetex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\pdforxetexfalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifpdf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \pdforxetextrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \pdforxetextrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Output page labels information.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% See PDF reference v.1.7 p.594, section 8.3.1.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifpdf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\pagelabels{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\title{0 << /P (T-) /S /D >>}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\roman{\the\romancount << /S /r >>}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\arabic{\the\arabiccount << /S /D >>}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Page label ranges must be increasing.  Remove any duplicates.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % (There is a slight chance of this being wrong if e.g. there is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % a @contents but no @titlepage, etc.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\romancount=0 \def\roman{}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\arabiccount=0 \def\title{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum\romancount=\arabiccount \def\roman{}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\romancount<\arabiccount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \pdfcatalog{/PageLabels << /Nums [\title \roman \arabic ] >> }\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \pdfcatalog{/PageLabels << /Nums [\title \arabic \roman ] >> }\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\pagelabels\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\pagecount \pagecount=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\romancount \romancount=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\arabiccount \arabiccount=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifpdf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\ptxadvancepageno\advancepageno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\advancepageno{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ptxadvancepageno\global\advance\pagecount by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% for display in the outlines, and in other places.  Thus, we have to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% double any backslashes.  Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e.  Not good.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% See http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% related messages.  The final outcome is that it is up to the TeX user
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% that's what we do.  pdftex 1.30.0 (ca.2005) introduced a primitive to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% do this reliably, so we use it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% which we \xdef.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\txiescapepdf#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\pdfescapestring\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % No primitive available; should we give a warning or log?
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Many times it won't matter.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \xdef#1{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % The expandable \pdfescapestring primitive escapes parentheses,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % backslashes, and other special chars.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \xdef#1{\pdfescapestring{#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\txiescapepdfutfsixteen#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\pdfescapestrutfsixteen\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % No UTF-16 converting macro available.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \txiescapepdf{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \xdef#1{\pdfescapestrutfsixteen{#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found.  (.eps cannot
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								output) for that.)}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifpdf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Color manipulation macros using ideas from pdfcolor.tex,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % except using rgb instead of cmyk; the latter is said to render as a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % very dark gray on-screen and a very dark halftone in print, instead
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % of actual black. The dark red here is dark enough to print on paper as
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing.  We use
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % black by default, though.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % rg sets the color for filling (usual text, etc.);
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % RG sets the color for stroking (thin rules, e.g., normal _'s).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 rg  #1 RG}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\setcolor#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \xdef\currentcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \domark
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\currentcolordefs{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\makefootline{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \baselineskip24pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\makeheadline{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \vbox to 0pt{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \vskip-22.5pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \line{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \vbox to8.5pt{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \getcolormarks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \vss
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nointerlineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\pdfimagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\pdfimageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .pdf, .png, .jpg (among
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % others).  Let's try in that order, PDF first since if
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % bitmap.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\pdfimgext=\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \closein 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % included twice.  (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \immediate\pdfimage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \immediate\pdfximage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \pdfimagewidth \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \pdfimageheight \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         #1.\pdfimgext
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         {#1.\pdfimgext}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\setpdfdestname#1{{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \indexnofonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \makevalueexpandable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \turnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \iftxiuseunicodedestname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % Pass through Latin-1 characters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % LuaTeX with byte wise I/O converts Latin-1 characters to Unicode.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % Pass through Unicode characters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % Use ASCII approximations in destination names.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \passthroughcharsfalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Use ASCII approximations in destination names.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \passthroughcharsfalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\setpdfoutlinetext#1{{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \indexnofonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \makevalueexpandable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \turnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % The PDF format can use an extended form of Latin-1 in bookmark
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % strings.  See Appendix D of the PDF Reference, Sixth Edition, for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % the "PDFDocEncoding".
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \passthroughcharstrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Pass through Latin-1 characters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %   LuaTeX: Convert to Unicode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %   pdfTeX: Use Latin-1 as PDFDocEncoding
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % For pdfTeX  with UTF-8.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % TODO: the PDF format can use UTF-16 in bookmark strings,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % but the code for this isn't done yet.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % Use ASCII approximations.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \passthroughcharsfalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % For LuaTeX with UTF-8.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % Pass through Unicode characters for title texts.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \passthroughcharstrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % For non-Latin-1 or non-UTF-8 encodings.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % Use ASCII approximations.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \passthroughcharsfalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % LuaTeX: Convert to UTF-16
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % pdfTeX: Use Latin-1 as PDFDocEncoding
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \txiescapepdfutfsixteen\pdfoutlinetext
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdfmkdest#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setpdfdestname{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % by default, use black for everything.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\urlcolor{\rgbBlack}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\linkcolor{\rgbBlack}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % come from Petr Olsak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\tempnum by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % outline by the pdf viewer.  #2 is the pdf expression for the number
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections).  #3 is the node text,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % #4 is the page number
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % page number.  We could generate a destination for the section
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setpdfoutlinetext{#1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setpdfdestname{#3}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\pdfdestname{#4}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfdestname}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\def\thischapnum{##2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\def\thissecnum{0}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\def\thissubsecnum{0}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\def\thissecnum{##2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\def\thissubsecnum{0}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\thischapnum{0}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\thissecnum{0}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % al. a second time, below.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \readdatafile{toc}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % We use the node names as the destinations.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Currently we prefix the section name with the section number
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % for chapter and appendix headings only in order to avoid too much
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % horizontal space being required in the PDF viewer.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \dopdfoutline{##2 ##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\unnchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % document fonts.  Therefore we cannot use special characters,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % since the encoding is unknown.  For example, the eogonek from
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character.  Info from
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % TODO this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding.  Too
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % much work for too little return.  Just use the ASCII equivalents
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % we use for the index sort strings.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \indexnofonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setupdatafile
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Texinfo index files.  So set that up.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \input \tocreadfilename
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ]
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance\filenamelength by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nextsp}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\getfilename#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \filenamelength=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % snagged on things like "@value{foo}".
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \edef\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % make a live url in pdf output.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdfurl#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % of @url.  for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % people have actually reported a problem with.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \normalturnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\@{@}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\/=\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \makevalueexpandable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % special-casing \var here?
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\var##1{##1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \pdfgettoks - Surround page numbers in #1 with @pdflink.  #1 may
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % be a simple number, or a list of numbers in the case of an index
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % entry.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\maketoks{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\first0\adn0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \let\next=\maketoks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \next}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdflink#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % non-pdf mode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\pdfurl = \gobble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\endlink = \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\setcolor = \gobble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi  % \ifx\pdfoutput
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For XeTeX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % XeTeX version check
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\strcmp{\the\XeTeXversion\XeTeXrevision}{0.99996}>-1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % TeX Live 2016 contains XeTeX 0.99996 and xdvipdfmx 20160307.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % It can use the `dvipdfmx:config' special (from TeX Live SVN r40941).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % For avoiding PDF destination name replacement, we use this special
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % instead of xdvipdfmx's command line option `-C 0x0010'.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \special{dvipdfmx:config C 0x0010}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % XeTeX 0.99995+ comes with xdvipdfmx 20160307+.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % It can handle Unicode destination names for PDF.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \txiuseunicodedestnametrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % XeTeX < 0.99996 (TeX Live < 2016) cannot use the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % `dvipdfmx:config' special.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % So for avoiding PDF destination name replacement,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % xdvipdfmx's command line option `-C 0x0010' is necessary.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % XeTeX < 0.99995 can not handle Unicode destination names for PDF
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % because xdvipdfmx 20150315 has a UTF-16 conversion issue.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % It is fixed by xdvipdfmx 20160106 (TeX Live SVN r39753).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \txiuseunicodedestnamefalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Color support
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\special{pdf:scolor [#1]}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\setcolor#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \xdef\currentcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \domark
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\currentcolordefs{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\makefootline{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \baselineskip24pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\makeheadline{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \vbox to 0pt{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \vskip-22.5pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \line{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \vbox to8.5pt{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \getcolormarks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \vss
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nointerlineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % PDF outline support
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Emulate pdfTeX primitive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdfdest name#1 xyz{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \special{pdf:dest (#1) [@thispage /XYZ @xpos @ypos null]}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\setpdfdestname#1{{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \indexnofonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \makevalueexpandable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \turnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \iftxiuseunicodedestname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Pass through Unicode characters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Use ASCII approximations in destination names.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \passthroughcharsfalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\setpdfoutlinetext#1{{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \turnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Always use Unicode characters in title texts.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % For XeTeX, xdvipdfmx converts to UTF-16.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % So we do not convert.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinetext
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdfmkdest#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setpdfdestname{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % by default, use black for everything.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\urlcolor{\rgbBlack}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\linkcolor{\rgbBlack}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setpdfoutlinetext{#1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setpdfdestname{#3}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\pdfdestname{#4}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \special{pdf:out [-] #2 << /Title (\pdfoutlinetext) /A
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      << /S /GoTo /D (\pdfdestname) >> >> }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % For XeTeX, counts of subentries are not necessary.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Therefore, we read toc only once.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % We use node names as destinations.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Currently we prefix the section name with the section number
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % for chapter and appendix headings only in order to avoid too much
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % horizontal space being required in the PDF viewer.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \dopdfoutline{##2 ##1}{1}{##3}{##4}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \dopdfoutline{##1}{2}{##3}{##4}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \dopdfoutline{##1}{3}{##3}{##4}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \dopdfoutline{##1}{4}{##3}{##4}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\appentry\numchapentry%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\appsecentry\numsecentry%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\appsubsecentry\numsubsecentry%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\appsubsubsecentry\numsubsubsecentry%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\unnchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \dopdfoutline{##1}{1}{##3}{##4}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\unnsecentry\numsecentry%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\unnsubsecentry\numsubsecentry%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\unnsubsubsecentry\numsubsubsecentry%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % For XeTeX, xdvipdfmx converts strings to UTF-16.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Therefore, the encoding and the language may not be considered.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \indexnofonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setupdatafile
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Texinfo index files.  So set that up.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \input \tocreadfilename
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  ]
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \special{pdf:docview << /PageMode /UseOutlines >> }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % ``\special{pdf:tounicode ...}'' is not necessary
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % because xdvipdfmx converts strings from UTF-8 to UTF-16 without it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % However, due to a UTF-16 conversion issue of xdvipdfmx 20150315,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % ``\special{pdf:dest ...}'' cannot handle non-ASCII strings.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % It is fixed by xdvipdfmx 20160106 (TeX Live SVN r39753).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance\filenamelength by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nextsp}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\getfilename#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \filenamelength=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % snagged on things like "@value{foo}".
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \edef\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % make a live url in pdf output.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdfurl#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % of @url.  for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % people have actually reported a problem with.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \normalturnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\@{@}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\/=\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \makevalueexpandable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % special-casing \var here?
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\var##1{##1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0]
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        /Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >> >>}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\special{pdf:eann}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\maketoks{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\first0\adn0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \let\next=\maketoks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \next}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\pdflink#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0]
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      /Type /Annot /Subtype /Link /A << /S /GoTo /D (#1) >> >>}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % @image support
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\doxeteximage#1#2#3{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\xeteximagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\xeteximageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % XeTeX (and the PDF format) supports .pdf, .png, .jpg (among
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % others).  Let's try in that order, PDF first since if
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % bitmap.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\xeteximgext=\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for XeTeX}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                \else \gdef\xeteximgext{JPG}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              \else \gdef\xeteximgext{jpeg}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            \else \gdef\xeteximgext{jpg}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \else \gdef\xeteximgext{png}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \else \gdef\xeteximgext{PDF}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else \gdef\xeteximgext{pdf}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \closein 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\xetexpdfext{pdf}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\xeteximgext\xetexpdfext
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \XeTeXpdffile "#1".\xeteximgext ""
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\xetexpdfext{PDF}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifx\xeteximgext\xetexpdfext
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \XeTeXpdffile "#1".\xeteximgext ""
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \XeTeXpicfile "#1".\xeteximgext ""
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \xeteximagewidth \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \xeteximageheight \fi \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{fonts,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% correspondingly.  There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\baselinefactor{1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\textleading
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setleading#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dimen0 = #1\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \normalbaselines
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% PDF CMaps.  See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% do nothing with this by default.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\thisisundefined \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%Version: 1.000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%EndComments
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								12 dict begin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								begincmap
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/CIDSystemInfo
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<< /Registry (TeX)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/Ordering (OT1)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/Supplement 0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								>> def
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/CMapType 2 def
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								1 begincodespacerange
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<00> <7F>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								endcodespacerange
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								8 beginbfrange
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<00> <01> <0393>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<09> <0A> <03A8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<23> <26> <0023>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<28> <3B> <0028>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<3F> <5B> <003F>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<5D> <5E> <005D>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<61> <7A> <0061>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<7B> <7C> <2013>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								endbfrange
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								40 beginbfchar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<02> <0398>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<03> <039B>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<04> <039E>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<05> <03A0>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<06> <03A3>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<07> <03D2>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<08> <03A6>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<0B> <00660066>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<0C> <00660069>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<0D> <0066006C>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<0E> <006600660069>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<0F> <00660066006C>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<10> <0131>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<11> <0237>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<12> <0060>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<13> <00B4>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<14> <02C7>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<15> <02D8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<16> <00AF>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<17> <02DA>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<18> <00B8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<19> <00DF>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1A> <00E6>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1B> <0153>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1C> <00F8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1D> <00C6>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1E> <0152>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1F> <00D8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<21> <0021>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<22> <201D>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<27> <2019>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<3C> <00A1>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<3D> <003D>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<3E> <00BF>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<5C> <201C>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<5F> <02D9>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<60> <2018>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<7D> <02DD>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<7E> <007E>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<7F> <00A8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								endbfchar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								endcmap
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%EndResource
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%EOF
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }\endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \cmapOT1IT
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%Version: 1.000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%EndComments
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								12 dict begin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								begincmap
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/CIDSystemInfo
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<< /Registry (TeX)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/Ordering (OT1IT)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/Supplement 0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								>> def
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/CMapType 2 def
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								1 begincodespacerange
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<00> <7F>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								endcodespacerange
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								8 beginbfrange
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<00> <01> <0393>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<09> <0A> <03A8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<25> <26> <0025>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<28> <3B> <0028>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<3F> <5B> <003F>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<5D> <5E> <005D>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<61> <7A> <0061>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<7B> <7C> <2013>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								endbfrange
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								42 beginbfchar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<02> <0398>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<03> <039B>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<04> <039E>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<05> <03A0>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<06> <03A3>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<07> <03D2>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<08> <03A6>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<0B> <00660066>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<0C> <00660069>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<0D> <0066006C>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<0E> <006600660069>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<0F> <00660066006C>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<10> <0131>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<11> <0237>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<12> <0060>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<13> <00B4>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<14> <02C7>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<15> <02D8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<16> <00AF>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<17> <02DA>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<18> <00B8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<19> <00DF>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1A> <00E6>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1B> <0153>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1C> <00F8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1D> <00C6>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1E> <0152>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1F> <00D8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<21> <0021>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<22> <201D>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<23> <0023>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<24> <00A3>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<27> <2019>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<3C> <00A1>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<3D> <003D>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<3E> <00BF>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<5C> <201C>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<5F> <02D9>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<60> <2018>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<7D> <02DD>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<7E> <007E>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<7F> <00A8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								endbfchar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								endcmap
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%EndResource
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%EOF
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }\endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \cmapOT1TT
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%Version: 1.000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%EndComments
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								12 dict begin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								begincmap
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/CIDSystemInfo
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<< /Registry (TeX)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/Ordering (OT1TT)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/Supplement 0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								>> def
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								/CMapType 2 def
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								1 begincodespacerange
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<00> <7F>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								endcodespacerange
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								5 beginbfrange
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<00> <01> <0393>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<09> <0A> <03A8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<21> <26> <0021>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<28> <5F> <0028>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<61> <7E> <0061>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								endbfrange
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								32 beginbfchar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<02> <0398>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<03> <039B>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<04> <039E>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<05> <03A0>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<06> <03A3>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<07> <03D2>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<08> <03A6>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<0B> <2191>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<0C> <2193>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<0D> <0027>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<0E> <00A1>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<0F> <00BF>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<10> <0131>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<11> <0237>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<12> <0060>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<13> <00B4>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<14> <02C7>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<15> <02D8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<16> <00AF>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<17> <02DA>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<18> <00B8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<19> <00DF>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1A> <00E6>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1B> <0153>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1C> <00F8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1D> <00C6>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1E> <0152>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<1F> <00D8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<20> <2423>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<27> <2019>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<60> <2018>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								<7F> <00A8>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								endbfchar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								endcmap
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%EndResource
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%EOF
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }\endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Set the font macro #1 to the font named \fontprefix#2.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% encoding (only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, or empty to omit).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Example:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 = \textrm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #2 = \rmshape
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #3 = 10
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #4 = \mainmagstep
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #5 = OT1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\cmap\gobble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (end of cmaps)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Use cm as the default font prefix.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% before you read in texinfo.tex.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\fontprefix\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\fontprefix{cm}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\rmshape{r}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\rmbshape{bx}               % where the normal face is bold
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\bfshape{b}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\bxshape{bx}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ttshape{tt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ttbshape{tt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ttslshape{sltt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\itshape{ti}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\itbshape{bxti}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\slshape{sl}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\slbshape{bxsl}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sfshape{ss}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sfbshape{ss}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\scshape{csc}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\scbshape{csc}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Definitions for a main text size of 11pt.  (The default in Texinfo.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\definetextfontsizexi{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\textnominalsize{11pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\textecsize{1095}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% A few fonts for @defun names and args.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\defsl\slshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\df{\let\ttfont=\deftt \let\bffont = \defbf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ttslfont=\defttsl \let\slfont=\defsl \bf}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\smalli=cmmi9
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\smallsy=cmsy9
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\smallecsize{0900}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Fonts for small examples (8pt).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\smalleri=cmmi8
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\smallersy=cmsy8
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\smallerecsize{0800}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Fonts for math mode superscripts (7pt).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sevennominalsize{7pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\sevenrm\rmshape{7}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\seventt\ttshape{10}{700}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\sevenbf\bfshape{10}{700}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\sevenit\itshape{7}{1000}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\sevensl\slshape{10}{700}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\sevensf\sfshape{10}{700}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\sevensc\scshape{10}{700}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\seventtsl\ttslshape{10}{700}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\seveni=cmmi7
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\sevensy=cmsy7
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sevenecsize{0700}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\titlebf=\titlerm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\titleecsize{2074}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\chapbf=\chaprm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\chapecsize{1728}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Section fonts (14.4pt).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\secnominalsize{14pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\secrmnotbold\rmshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\secbf\secrm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sececsize{1440}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ssecbf\ssecrm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ssececsize{1200}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Reduced fonts for @acronym in text (10pt).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\reducedi=cmmi10
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\reducedsy=cmsy10
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\reducedecsize{1000}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\textleading = 13.2pt % line spacing for 11pt CM
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\textfonts            % reset the current fonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\rm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								} % end of 11pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizexi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit.  This is for the GNU
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual.  Maybe other manuals in the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% future.  Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\definetextfontsizex{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Text fonts (10pt).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\textnominalsize{10pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\edef\mainmagstep{1000}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\textecsize{1000}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% A few fonts for @defun names and args.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\defsl\slshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\df{\let\ttfont=\deftt \let\bffont = \defbf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\slfont=\defsl \let\ttslfont=\defttsl \bf}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\smalli=cmmi9
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\smallsy=cmsy9
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\smallecsize{0900}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Fonts for small examples (8pt).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\smalleri=cmmi8
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\smallersy=cmsy8
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\smallerecsize{0800}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Fonts for math mode superscripts (7pt).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sevennominalsize{7pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\sevenrm\rmshape{7}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\seventt\ttshape{10}{700}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\sevenbf\bfshape{10}{700}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\sevenit\itshape{7}{1000}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\sevensl\slshape{10}{700}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\sevensf\sfshape{10}{700}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\sevensc\scshape{10}{700}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\seventtsl\ttslshape{10}{700}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\seveni=cmmi7
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\sevensy=cmsy7
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sevenecsize{0700}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\titlebf=\titlerm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\titleecsize{2074}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\chapnominalsize{14pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\chapbf\chaprm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\chapecsize{1440}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Section fonts (12pt).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\secnominalsize{12pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\secbf\secrm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\seci=cmmi12
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sececsize{1200}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Subsection fonts (10pt).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ssecnominalsize{10pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ssecbf\ssecrm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\sseci=cmmi10
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\ssecsy=cmsy10
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ssececsize{1000}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Reduced fonts for @acronym in text (9pt).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\reducednominalsize{9pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\reducedi=cmmi9
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\font\reducedsy=cmsy9
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\reducedecsize{0900}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\divide\parskip by 2  % reduce space between paragraphs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\textleading = 12pt   % line spacing for 10pt CM
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\textfonts            % reset the current fonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\rm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								} % end of 10pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Fonts for short table of contents.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}  % no cmb12
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We provide the user-level command
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   @fonttextsize 10
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (or 11) to redefine the text font size.  pt is assumed.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\xiword{11}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\xword{10}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\xwordpt{10pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\textsizearg{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %\wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								 \begingroup \globaldefs=1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errhelp=\EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not `\textsizearg'}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								 \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% italics, not bold italics.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setfontstyle#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \csname #1font\endcsname  % change the current font
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}\def\ttstylename{tt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% So we set up a \sf.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newfam\sffam
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We don't need math for this font style.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% we have to define the \textfont of the standard families.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We don't bother to reset \scriptscriptfont; awaiting user need.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\resetmathfonts{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \textfont0=\rmfont \textfont1=\ifont \textfont2=\syfont
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \textfont\itfam=\itfont \textfont\slfam=\slfont \textfont\bffam=\bffont
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \textfont\ttfam=\ttfont \textfont\sffam=\sffont
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Fonts for superscript.  Note that the 7pt fonts are used regardless
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % of the current font size.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \scriptfont0=\sevenrm \scriptfont1=\seveni \scriptfont2=\sevensy
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \scriptfont\itfam=\sevenit \scriptfont\slfam=\sevensl
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \scriptfont\bffam=\sevenbf \scriptfont\ttfam=\seventt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \scriptfont\sffam=\sevensf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The font-changing commands (all called \...fonts) redefine the meanings
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% of \STYLEfont, instead of just \STYLE.  We do this because \STYLE needs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% to also set the current \fam for math mode.  Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% commands hardwire \STYLEfont to set the current font.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The fonts used for \ifont are for "math italics"  (\itfont is for italics
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% in regular text).  \syfont is also used in math mode only.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and \lllsize (three sizes lower).  These relative commands are used
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% in, e.g., the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This all needs generalizing, badly.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\assignfonts#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\expandafter\rmfont\csname #1rm\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\expandafter\itfont\csname #1it\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\expandafter\slfont\csname #1sl\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\expandafter\bffont\csname #1bf\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\expandafter\ttfont\csname #1tt\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\expandafter\smallcaps\csname #1sc\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\expandafter\sffont  \csname #1sf\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\expandafter\ifont   \csname #1i\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\expandafter\syfont  \csname #1sy\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\expandafter\ttslfont\csname #1ttsl\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifrmisbold
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Select smaller font size with the current style.  Used to change font size
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% in, e.g., the LaTeX logo and acronyms.  If we are using bold fonts for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% normal roman text, also use bold fonts for roman text in the smaller size.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\switchtolllsize{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \expandafter\assignfonts\expandafter{\lllsize}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \ifrmisbold
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \let\rmfont\bffont
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\switchtolsize{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \expandafter\assignfonts\expandafter{\lsize}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \ifrmisbold
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \let\rmfont\bffont
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\definefontsetatsize#1#2#3#4#5{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\expandafter\def\csname #1fonts\endcsname{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\curfontsize{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\lsize{#2}\def\lllsize{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \csname rmisbold#5\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \assignfonts{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \resetmathfonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setleading{#4}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\definefontsetatsize{text}   {reduced}{smaller}{\textleading}{false}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\definefontsetatsize{title}  {chap}   {subsec} {27pt}  {true}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\definefontsetatsize{chap}   {sec}    {text}   {19pt}  {true}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\definefontsetatsize{sec}    {subsec} {reduced}{17pt}  {true}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\definefontsetatsize{ssec}   {text}   {small}  {15pt}  {true}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\definefontsetatsize{reduced}{small}  {smaller}{10.5pt}{false}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\definefontsetatsize{small}  {smaller}{smaller}{10.5pt}{false}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\definefontsetatsize{smaller}{smaller}{smaller}{9.5pt} {false}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\subsecfonts = \ssecfonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\subsubsecfonts = \ssecfonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define these just so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\angleleft{$\langle$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\angleright{$\rangle$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% About \smallexamplefonts.  If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% can fit this many characters:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   8.5x11=86   smallbook=72  a4=90  a5=69
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   8.5x11=90+  smallbook=80  a4=90+  a5=77
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the additional smallness of 8pt.  So I'm making the default 9pt.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   8.5x11=71  smallbook=60  a4=75  a5=58
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% --karl, 24jan03.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\definetextfontsizexi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{markup,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Check if we are currently using a typewriter font.  Since all the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% this property, we can check that font parameter.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Markup style infrastructure.  \defmarkupstylesetup\INITMACRO will
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% define and register \INITMACRO to be called on markup style changes.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \INITMACRO can check \currentmarkupstyle for the innermost
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% style.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\currentmarkupstyle\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setupmarkupstyle#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\currentmarkupstyle{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \markupstylesetup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\markupstylesetup\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\defmarkupstylesetup#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\def\expandafter\markupstylesetup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter{\markupstylesetup #1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def#1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Markup style setup for left and right quotes.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuplq{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \csname markupsetuplq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuplqdefault \else \temp \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuprq{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \csname markupsetuprq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuprqdefault \else \temp \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\'=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\`=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\markupsetuplqdefault{\let`\lq}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\markupsetuprqdefault{\let'\rq}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\markupsetcodequoteleft{\let`\codequoteleft}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\markupsetcodequoteright{\let'\codequoteright}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\markupsetuplqcode \markupsetcodequoteleft
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\markupsetuprqcode \markupsetcodequoteright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\markupsetuplqexample \markupsetcodequoteleft
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\markupsetuprqexample \markupsetcodequoteright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\markupsetuplqkbd     \markupsetcodequoteleft
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\markupsetuprqkbd     \markupsetcodequoteright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\markupsetuplqsamp \markupsetcodequoteleft
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\markupsetuprqsamp \markupsetcodequoteright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\markupsetuplqverb \markupsetcodequoteleft
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\markupsetuprqverb \markupsetcodequoteright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\markupsetuplqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteleft
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\markupsetuprqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Allow an option to not use regular directed right quote/apostrophe
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (char 0x27), but instead the undirected quote from cmtt (char 0x0d).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it the default, but it
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least evince), the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% lilypond developers report.  xpdf does work with the regular 0x27.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\codequoteright{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifmonospace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        '%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else \char'15 \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else \char'15 \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     '%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the code environments to do likewise.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\codequoteleft{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifmonospace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % \relax disables Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \relax`%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else \char'22 \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else \char'22 \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \relax`%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Commands to set the quote options.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\codequoteundirected{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\onword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      = t%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\temp\offword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      = \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errhelp = \EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errmessage{Unknown @codequoteundirected value `\temp', must be on|off}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\codequotebacktick{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\onword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      = t%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\temp\offword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      = \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errhelp = \EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errmessage{Unknown @codequotebacktick value `\temp', must be on|off}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391, disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\noligaturesquoteleft{\relax\lq}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Font commands.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is the font command (\sl or \it), #2 is the text to slant.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If we are in a monospaced environment, however, 1) always use \ttsl,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and 2) do not add an italic correction.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dosmartslant#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifusingtt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {{\ttsl #2}\let\next=\relax}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {\def\next{{#1#2}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\smartslanted{\dosmartslant\sl}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\smartitalic{\dosmartslant\it}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Output an italic correction unless \next (presumed to be the following
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% character) is such as not to need one.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\smartitaliccorrection{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\next,%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\next-%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\next.%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\next\.%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\next\comma%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ptexslash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \aftersmartic
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Unconditional use \ttsl, and no ic.  @var is set to this for defuns.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @cite is like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl.  We never want
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% ttsl for book titles, do we?
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\aftersmartic{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\var#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\saveaftersmartic = \aftersmartic
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\aftersmartic{\null\let\aftersmartic=\saveaftersmartic}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \smartslanted{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\i=\smartitalic
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\slanted=\smartslanted
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\dfn=\smartslanted
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\emph=\smartitalic
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\r#1{{\rm #1}}              % roman font
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}}       % smallcaps font
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ii#1{{\it #1}}             % italic font
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @b, explicit bold.  Also @strong.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\strong=\b
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @sansserif, explicit sans.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the end of a paragraph.  Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1  \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`@=11
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \sfcode`\.=\@m \sfcode`\?=\@m \sfcode`\!=\@m
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \sfcode`\:=\@m \sfcode`\;=\@m \sfcode`\,=\@m
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`@=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @t, explicit typewriter.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\t#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\tt \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \null
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @samp.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\samp#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{samp}\lq\tclose{#1}\rq\null}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @indicateurl is \samp, that is, with quotes.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\indicateurl=\samp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @code (and similar) prints in typewriter, but with spaces the same
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% size as normal in the surrounding text, without hyphenation, etc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This is a subroutine for that.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\tclose#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Switch to typewriter.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \tt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Turn off hyphenation.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nohyphenation
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \plainfrenchspacing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    #1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \null % reset spacefactor to 1000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (But see \codedashfinish below.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. -- rms.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let'=\rq \global\let`=\lq  % default definitions
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\def\code{\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % The following should really be moved into \setupmarkupstyle handlers.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \catcode\dashChar=\active  \catcode\underChar=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifallowcodebreaks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \let-\codedash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \let_\codeunder
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \let-\normaldash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \let_\realunder
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Given -foo (with a single dash), we do not want to allow a break
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % after the hyphen.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\let\codedashprev=\codedash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \codex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\codedash{\futurelet\next\codedashfinish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\codedashfinish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \normaldash % always output the dash character itself.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Now, output a discretionary to allow a line break, unless
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % (a) the next character is a -, or
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % (b) the preceding character is a -.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % E.g., given --posix, we do not want to allow a break after either -.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Given --foo-bar, we do want to allow a break between the - and the b.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\next\codedash \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifx\codedashprev\codedash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else \discretionary{}{}{}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % we need the space after the = for the case when \next itself is a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % space token; it would get swallowed otherwise.  As in @code{- a}.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\let\codedashprev= \next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\normaldash{-}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\codeunder{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work.  In math mode, _
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifusingtt{\ifmmode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								               \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								             \else\normalunderscore \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								             \discretionary{}{}{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            {\_}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% each of the four underscores in __typeof__.  This is bad.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @allowcodebreaks provides a document-level way to turn breaking at -
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and _ on and off.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifallowcodebreaks  \allowcodebreakstrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\keywordtrue{true}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\keywordfalse{false}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\txiarg{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \allowcodebreakstrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \allowcodebreaksfalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errhelp = \EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg', must be true|false}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For @command, @env, @file, @option quotes seem unnecessary,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% so use \code rather than \samp.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\command=\code
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\env=\code
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\file=\code
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\option=\code
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') aka @url takes an optional
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (comma-separated) second argument specifying the text to display and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% an optional third arg as text to display instead of (rather than in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% addition to) the url itself.  First (mandatory) arg is the url.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% TeX-only option to allow changing PDF output to show only the second
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% arg (if given), and not the url (which is then just the link target).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifurefurlonlylink
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The default \pretolerance setting stops the penalty inserted in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \urefallowbreak being a discouragement to line breaking.  Set it to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% a negative value for this paragraph only.  Hopefully this does not
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% conflict with redefinitions of \par done elsewhere.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\nopretolerance{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\pretolerance=-1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\par{\endgraf\pretolerance=100 \let\par\endgraf}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The main macro is \urefbreak, which allows breaking at expected
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% places within the url.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\urefbreak{\nopretolerance \begingroup \urefcatcodes \dourefbreak}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\uref=\urefbreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dourefbreak#1{\urefbreakfinish #1,,,\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\urefbreakfinish#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% doesn't work in @example
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \unsepspaces
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \pdfurl{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% look for second arg
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifpdf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % For pdfTeX and LuaTeX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifurefurlonlylink
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % PDF plus option to not display url, show just arg
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \unhbox0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % PDF, normally display both arg and url for consistency,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % visibility, if the pdf is eventually used to print, etc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})% DVI, always show arg and url
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % For XeTeX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \ifurefurlonlylink
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            % PDF plus option to not display url, show just arg
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            \unhbox0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            % PDF, normally display both arg and url for consistency,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            % visibility, if the pdf is eventually used to print, etc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \urefcode{#1}% only url given, so show it
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endlink
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Allow line breaks around only a few characters (only).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\urefcatcodes{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\&=\active \catcode`\.=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\#=\active \catcode`\?=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\/=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \urefcatcodes
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\def\urefcode{\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \urefcatcodes
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let&\urefcodeamp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let.\urefcodedot
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let#\urefcodehash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let?\urefcodequest
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let/\urefcodeslash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \codex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % By default, they are just regular characters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\def&{\normalamp}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\def.{\normaldot}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\def#{\normalhash}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\def?{\normalquest}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\def/{\normalslash}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\urefcodeamp{\urefprebreak \&\urefpostbreak}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\urefcodedot{\urefprebreak .\urefpostbreak}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\urefcodehash{\urefprebreak \#\urefpostbreak}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\urefcodequest{\urefprebreak ?\urefpostbreak}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\urefcodeslash{\futurelet\next\urefcodeslashfinish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\/=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\def\urefcodeslashfinish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \urefprebreak \slashChar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Allow line break only after the final / in a sequence of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % slashes, to avoid line break between the slashes in http://.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\next/\else \urefpostbreak \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% By default we'll break after the special characters, but some people like to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% break before the special chars, so allow that.  Also allow no breaking at
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% all, for manual control.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\urefbreakstyle{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\txiarg{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\txiarg\wordnone
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\txiarg\wordbefore
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\urefprebreak{\urefallowbreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\txiarg\wordafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\urefallowbreak}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errhelp = \EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errmessage{Unknown @urefbreakstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\wordafter{after}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\wordbefore{before}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\wordnone{none}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Allow a ragged right output to aid breaking long URL's.  There can
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% be a break at the \allowbreak with no extra glue (if the existing stretch in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the line is sufficient), a break at the \penalty with extra glue added
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% at the end of the line, or no break at all here.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   Changing the value of the penalty and/or the amount of stretch affects how
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% preferable one choice is over the other.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\urefallowbreak{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \penalty0\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hskip 0pt plus 2 em\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \penalty1000\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hskip 0pt plus -2 em\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\urefbreakstyle after
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\url=\uref
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifpdforxetex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \unsepspaces
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endlink
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\email=\uref
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\txiarg{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errhelp = \EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\worddistinct{distinct}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\wordexample{example}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\wordcode{code}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Default is `distinct'.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\kbdinputstyle distinct
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% then @kbd has no effect.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\kbd#1{{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdsub\look??\par}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\xkey{\key}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\kbdsub#1#2#3\par{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% definition of @key that produces a lozenge.  Doesn't adjust to text size.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%\font\keysy=cmsy9
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%  \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%    \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%     \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%    \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%  \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% definition of @key with no lozenge.  If the current font is already
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% monospace, don't change it; that way, we respect @kbdinputstyle.  But
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% if it isn't monospace, then use \tt.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\key#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{key}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nohyphenation
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifmonospace\else\tt\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  #1}\null}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @clickstyle @arrow   (by default)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\click{\arrow}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'.  The only reason for the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% all-uppercase.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\switchtolsize #1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\empty \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\empty \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @asis just yields its argument.  Used with @table, for example.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\asis#1{#1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @math outputs its argument in math mode.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}.  So make
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% which is what @var uses.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\_ = \active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\mathunderscore{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \catcode`\_=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a math (or tt) \.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (for no
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% particular reason), but this is not advertised and we don't care.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\math{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifmmode\else % only go into math if not in math mode already
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \tex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \mathunderscore
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\\ = \mathbackslash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \mathactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\"=\ddot
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\'=\acute
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\==\bar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\^=\hat
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\`=\grave
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\u=\breve
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\v=\check
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\~=\tilde
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\dotaccent=\dot
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % have to provide another name for sup operator
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\mathopsup=\sup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  $\expandafter\finishmath\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup}  % Close the group opened by \tex.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`^ = \active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`< = \active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`> = \active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`+ = \active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`' = \active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\mathactive{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let^ = \ptexhat
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let< = \ptexless
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let> = \ptexgtr
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let+ = \ptexplus
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let' = \ptexquoteright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% for @sub and @sup, if in math mode, just do a normal sub/superscript.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If in text, use math to place as sub/superscript, but switch
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% into text mode, with smaller fonts.  This is a different font than the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% one used for real math sub/superscripts (8pt vs. 7pt), but let's not
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% fix it (significant additions to font machinery) until someone notices.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sub{\ifmmode \expandafter\sb \else \expandafter\finishsub\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\finishsub#1{$\sb{\hbox{\switchtolllsize #1}}$}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sup{\ifmmode \expandafter\ptexsp \else \expandafter\finishsup\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\finishsup#1{$\ptexsp{\hbox{\switchtolllsize #1}}$}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% provide this command from LaTeX as it is very common
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\frac#1#2{{{#1}\over{#2}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @displaymath.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \globaldefs is needed to recognize the end lines in \tex and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \end tex.  Set \thisenv as @end displaymath is seen before @end tex.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\obeylines
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\globaldefs=1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\displaymath{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\tex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\thisenv{\displaymath}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								$$%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Edisplaymath{$$
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\thisenv{\tex}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\end tex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @inlinefmt{FMTNAME,PROCESSED-TEXT} and @inlineraw{FMTNAME,RAW-TEXT}.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Ignore unless FMTNAME == tex; then it is like @iftex and @tex,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% except specified as a normal braced arg, so no newlines to worry about.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\outfmtnametex{tex}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\long\def\inlinefmt#1{\doinlinefmt #1,\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\long\def\doinlinefmt#1,#2,\finish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @inlinefmtifelse{FMTNAME,THEN-TEXT,ELSE-TEXT} expands THEN-TEXT if
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% FMTNAME is tex, else ELSE-TEXT.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\long\def\inlinefmtifelse#1{\doinlinefmtifelse #1,,,\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\long\def\doinlinefmtifelse#1,#2,#3,#4,\finish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\else \ignorespaces #3\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For raw, must switch into @tex before parsing the argument, to avoid
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% setting catcodes prematurely.  Doing it this way means that, for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% example, @inlineraw{html, foo{bar} gets a parse error instead of being
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% ignored.  But this isn't important because if people want a literal
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% *right* brace they would have to use a command anyway, so they may as
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% well use a command to get a left brace too.  We could re-use the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% delimiter character idea from \verb, but it seems like overkill.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\long\def\inlineraw{\tex \doinlineraw}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\long\def\doinlineraw#1{\doinlinerawtwo #1,\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doinlinerawtwo#1,#2,\finish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\inlinerawname{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\inlinerawname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup % close group opened by \tex.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @inlineifset{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is @set.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\long\def\inlineifset#1{\doinlineifset #1,\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\long\def\doinlineifset#1,#2,\finish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ignorespaces#2\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @inlineifclear{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is not @set.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\long\def\inlineifclear#1{\doinlineifclear #1,\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\long\def\doinlineifclear#1,#2,\finish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax \ignorespaces#2\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{glyphs,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and logos.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @@ prints an @, as does @atchar{}.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\@{\char64 }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\atchar=\@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @{ @} @lbracechar{} @rbracechar{} all generate brace characters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\lbracechar{{\ifmonospace\char123\else\ensuremath\lbrace\fi}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\rbracechar{{\ifmonospace\char125\else\ensuremath\rbrace\fi}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\{=\lbracechar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\}=\rbracechar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\comma = ,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\, = \ptexc
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\dotaccent = \ptexdot
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\tieaccent = \ptext
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ubaraccent = \ptexb
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\udotaccent = \d
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\questiondown{?`}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\exclamdown{!`}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\switchtolllsize \underbar{a}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\switchtolllsize \underbar{o}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\imacro{i}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\jmacro{j}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dotless#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% period following counts as ending a sentence.  (Idea found in latex.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @LaTeX{} logo.  Not quite the same results as the definition in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \scriptscriptstyle).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\LaTeX{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  L\kern-.36em
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \ifx\textnominalsize\xwordpt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % for 10pt running text, lllsize (8pt) is too small for the A in LaTeX.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % Revert to plain's \scriptsize, which is 7pt.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \count255=\the\fam $\fam\count255 \scriptstyle A$%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % For 11pt, we can use our lllsize.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \switchtolllsize A%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \vss
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \kern-.15em
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \TeX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Some math mode symbols.  Define \ensuremath to switch into math mode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% unless we are already there.  Expansion tricks may not be needed here,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% but safer, and can't hurt.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ensuremath{\ifmmode \expandafter\asis \else\expandafter\ensuredmath \fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ensuredmath#1{$\relax#1$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\bullet{\ensuremath\ptexbullet}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\geq{\ensuremath\ge}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\leq{\ensuremath\le}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\minus{\ensuremath-}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em.  So do
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% whichever is larger.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dots{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \leavevmode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \dimen0 = \wd0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \dimen0 = 1.5em
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hbox to \dimen0{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \hskip 0pt plus.25fil
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\enddots{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dots
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\point{$\star$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\rightarrow$\hfil}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The @error{} command.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newbox\errorbox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\ttfont \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf \putworderror\kern-1.5pt}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \vbox{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \hrule height\dimen2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt          % Space to left of text.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \hrule height\dimen2}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \hfil}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\pounds{\ifmonospace{\ecfont\char"BF}\else{\it\$}\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% that.  The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% font height.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% feymr - regular
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% feymo - slanted
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% feybr - bold
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% feybo - bold slanted
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Hmm.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Also doesn't work in math.  Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Hope not.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\eurofont{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % font installed.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % that to the current nominal size.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % bold:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % regular:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \thiseurofont
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Glyphs from the EC fonts.  We don't use \let for the aliases, because
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% sometimes we redefine the original macro, and the alias should reflect
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the redefinition.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Use LaTeX names for the Icelandic letters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\DH{{\ecfont \char"D0}} % Eth
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dh{{\ecfont \char"F0}} % eth
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\TH{{\ecfont \char"DE}} % Thorn
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\th{{\ecfont \char"FE}} % thorn
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This positioning is not perfect (see the ogonek LaTeX package), but
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% we have the precomposed glyphs for the most common cases.  We put the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% tests to use those glyphs in the single \ogonek macro so we have fewer
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% dummy definitions to worry about for index entries, etc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% ogonek is also used with other letters in Lithuanian (IOU), but using
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the precomposed glyphs for those is not so easy since they aren't in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the same EC font.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ogonek#1{{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\macrocharA\Aogonek
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\temp\macrochara\aogonek
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\temp\macrocharE\Eogonek
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\temp\macrochare\eogonek
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ecfont \setbox0=\hbox{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifdim\ht0=1ex\accent"0C #1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ooalign{\unhbox0\crcr\hidewidth\char"0C \hidewidth}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Aogonek{{\ecfont \char"81}}\def\macrocharA{A}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\aogonek{{\ecfont \char"A1}}\def\macrochara{a}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Eogonek{{\ecfont \char"86}}\def\macrocharE{E}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\eogonek{{\ecfont \char"A6}}\def\macrochare{e}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Use the European Computer Modern fonts (cm-super in outline format)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% for non-CM glyphs.  That is ec* for regular text and tc* for the text
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% companion symbols (LaTeX TS1 encoding).  Both are part of the ec
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% package and follow the same conventions.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ecfont{\etcfont{e}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\tcfont{\etcfont{t}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\etcfont#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % We can't distinguish serif/sans and italic/slanted, but this
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifmonospace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % typewriter:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \font\thisecfont = #1ctt\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % bold:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \font\thisecfont = #1cb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % regular:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \font\thisecfont = #1c\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \thisecfont
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @registeredsymbol - R in a circle.  The font for the R should really
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\registeredsymbol{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\switchtolllsize R}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								               \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }$%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\textdegree{$^\circ$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%  Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14)  (68K)  16 APR 2004 02:38
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% so we'll define it if necessary.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\Orb\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Quotes.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\chardef\quoteleft=`\`
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\chardef\quoteright=`\'
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% only change font for tt for correct kerning and to avoid using
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \ecfont unless necessary.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\quotedblleft{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifmonospace{\ecfont\char"10}\else{\char"5C}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\quotedblright{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifmonospace{\ecfont\char"11}\else{\char`\"}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{page headings,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% First the title page.  Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifseenauthor
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\iffinishedtitlepage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @setcontentsaftertitlepage used to do an implicit @contents or
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @shortcontents after @end titlepage, but it is now obsolete.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setcontentsaftertitlepage{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \errmessage{@setcontentsaftertitlepage has been removed as a Texinfo
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              command; move your @contents command if you want the contents
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              after the title page.}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \errmessage{@setshortcontentsaftertitlepage has been removed as a Texinfo
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              command; move your @shortcontents and @contents commands if you
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              want the contents after the title page.}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\shorttitlepage{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup \hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\titlepage{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \parindent=0pt \textfonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \vglue\titlepagetopglue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \finishedtitlepagetrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % at the top of the second.  We don't want the ragged left on the second.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\oldpage = \page
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\page{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \iffinishedtitlepage\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									 \finishtitlepage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\page = \oldpage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \page
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \null
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Etitlepage{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \iffinishedtitlepage\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\finishtitlepage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \oldpage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \HEADINGSon
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\finishtitlepage{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \finishedtitlepagetrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Settings used for typesetting titles: no hyphenation, no indentation,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% don't worry much about spacing, ragged right.  This should be used
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% inside a \vbox, and fonts need to be set appropriately first. \par should
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% be specified before the end of the \vbox, since a vbox is a group.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\raggedtitlesettings{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \rm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hyphenpenalty=10000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parindent=0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tolerance=5000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ptexraggedright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Macros to be used within @titlepage:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\subtitlerm=\rmfont
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\title{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \checkenv\titlepage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vbox{\titlefonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % print a rule at the page bottom also.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \finishedtitlepagefalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\subtitle{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \checkenv\titlepage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @author should come last, but may come many times.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% It can also be used inside @quotation.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\author{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{\quotation}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\thisenv\temp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \checkenv\titlepage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {\secfonts\rm \leftline{#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Set up page headings and footings.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\thispage=\folio
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newtoks\evenheadline    % headline on even pages
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newtoks\oddheadline     % headline on odd pages
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newtoks\evenchapheadline% headline on even pages with a new chapter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newtoks\oddchapheadline % headline on odd pages with a new chapter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newtoks\evenfootline    % footline on even pages
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newtoks\oddfootline     % footline on odd pages
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Now make \makeheadline and \makefootline in Plain TeX use those variables
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\headline={{\textfonts\rm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            \ifchapterpage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              \ifodd\pageno\the\oddchapheadline\else\the\evenchapheadline\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              \ifodd\pageno\the\oddheadline\else\the\evenheadline\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								            \fi}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                            \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\HEADINGShook=\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Commands to set those variables.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For example, this is what  @headings on  does
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @evenfooting @thisfile||
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @oddfooting ||@thisfile
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\evenchapheadline=\evenheadline}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\oddchapheadline=\oddheadline}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Leave some space for the footline.  Hopefully ok to assume
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\advance\txipageheight by -12pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\advance\vsize by -12pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @evenheadingmarks top     \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @evenheadingmarks bottom  \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The same set of arguments for:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @oddheadingmarks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @evenfootingmarks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @oddfootingmarks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @everyheadingmarks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @everyfootingmarks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% These define \getoddheadingmarks, \getevenheadingmarks,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \getoddfootingmarks, and \getevenfootingmarks, each to one of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \gettopheadingmarks, \getbottomheadingmarks.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\everyheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                          \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\everyfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                          \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\everyheadingmarks bottom
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\everyfootingmarks bottom
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @headings double      turns headings on for double-sided printing.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @headings single      turns headings on for single-sided printing.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @headings off         turns them off.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @headings on          same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @headings after       turns on double-sided headings after this page.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% By default, they are off at the start of a document,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\headings{\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\headingsoff{% non-global headings elimination
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}\evenchapheadline={\hfil}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}\oddchapheadline={\hfil}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\HEADINGSoff{{\globaldefs=1 \headingsoff}} % global setting
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\HEADINGSoff  % it's the default
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\pageone{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\pageno=1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\arabiccount = \pagecount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% edge of all pages.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\HEADINGSdouble{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\pageone
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\HEADINGSdoublex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% page number on top right.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\HEADINGSsingle{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\pageone
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\HEADINGSsinglex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\evenchapheadline={\line{\folio\hfil}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\oddchapheadline={\line{\hfil\folio}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\evenchapheadline={\line{\hfil\folio}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\oddchapheadline={\line{\hfil\folio}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% for @setchapternewpage off
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\HEADINGSsinglechapoff{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\pageone
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\evenchapheadline=\evenheadline
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\oddchapheadline=\oddheadline
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Subroutines used in generating headings
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This produces Day Month Year style of output.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\today\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\today{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \number\day\space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifcase\month
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \space\number\year}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @settitle line...  specifies the title of the document, for headings.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% It generates no output of its own.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{tables,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% default indentation of table text
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\itemindent  \itemindent=.3in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% margin between end of table item and start of table text.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\itemmargin  \itemmargin=.1in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\itemmax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% these defs.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% They also define \itemindex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \itemindex{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % line.  We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % but leave it ragged-right.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance\hsize by\tableindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up.  However, if
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % cause the example and the item to crash together.  So we use this
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % \parskip glue after all.  Section titles are handled this way also.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \penalty 10001
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % The item text fits into the space.  Start a paragraph, so that the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \noindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % eventually be printed.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nobreak\kern-\tableindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \dimen0 = \itemmax  \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \unhbox0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nobreak\kern\dimen0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @table, @ftable, @vtable.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\table{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\itemindex\gobble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tablecheck{table}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\ftable{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tablecheck{ftable}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\vtable{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tablecheck{vtable}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\tablecheck#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\next\tablex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\tablex#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\itemindicate{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parsearg\tabley
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\tabley#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \makevalueexpandable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }\temp \endtablez
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \aboveenvbreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \itemmax=\tableindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \exdentamount=\tableindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parindent = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parskip = \smallskipamount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\item = \internalBitem
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\Eftable\Etable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\Evtable\Etable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\Eitemize\Etable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\Eenumerate\Etable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount \itemno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doitemize#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \aboveenvbreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \itemmax=\itemindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\leftskip by \itemindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \exdentamount=\itemindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parindent=0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parskip=\smallskipamount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Try typesetting the item mark so that if the document erroneously says
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % something like @itemize @samp (intending @table), there's an error
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % right away at the @itemize.  It's not the best error message in the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % world, but it's better than leaving it to the @item.  This means if
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % the user wants an empty mark, they have to say @w{} not just @w.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\itemcontents{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox0 = \hbox{\itemcontents}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\item=\itemizeitem
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\itemizeitem{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\itemno by 1  % for enumerations
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   % done a \vskip-\parskip.  In that case, we don't want to zero
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading.  On the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   % space.  In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before.  At least
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   % that's the theory.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \noindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \ifinner\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \vadjust{\penalty 1200}% not good to break after first line of item.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   % We can be in inner vertical mode in a footnote, although an
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   % @itemize looks awful there.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \flushcr
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list.  No
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% argument is the same as `1'.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1  \endenumeratey}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\thearg{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Detect if the argument is a single token.  If so, it might be a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % letter.  Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\rest\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Only one token in the argument.  It could still be anything.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %   not equal to itself.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % continuing to look for a <number>.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % It's a letter.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Multiple tokens in the argument.  We hope it's a number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \numericenumerate
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% An @enumerate whose labels are integers.  The starting integer is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% given in \thearg.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\numericenumerate{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \itemno = \thearg
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\lowercaseenumerate{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \startenumeration{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum\itemno=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  alphabet}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \char\lccode\itemno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\uppercaseenumerate{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \startenumeration{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum\itemno=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  alphabet}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \char\uccode\itemno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% common last two arguments.  Also subtract one from the initial value in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\startenumeration#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\itemno by -1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% to @enumerate.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @multitable macros
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble.  Width
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% To make preamble:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   @item ...
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   columns as desired.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Or use a template:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   @item ...
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   using the widest term desired in each column.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% if they are.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Sample multitable:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   @item
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   first col stuff
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   @tab
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   second col stuff
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   @tab
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   third col
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%         They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   @end multitable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Default dimensions may be reset by user.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%                                                            to baseline.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\multitableparskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\multitableparindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\multitablecolspace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\multitablelinespace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\multitableparskip=0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\multitableparindent=6pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\multitablecolspace=12pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\multitablelinespace=0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Macros used to set up halign preamble:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\endsetuptable\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\columnfractions\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifsetpercent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% be just 1.  We just use it, whatever it is.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\advance\colcount by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setuptable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\colcount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setuptable#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\firstarg{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\go = \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \global\setpercenttrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifsetpercent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         \let\go\pickupwholefraction
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         \global\advance\colcount by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                   % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\go = \setuptable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \go
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% multitable-only commands.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold.  Assignments
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% have to be global since we are inside the implicit group of an
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% alignment entry.  \everycr below resets \everytab so we don't have to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% undo it ourselves.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\headitemfont{\b}% for people to use in the template row; not changeable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\headitem{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \checkenv\multitable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \crcr
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\headitemcrhook{\nobreak}% attempt to avoid page break after headings
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\everytab={\bf}% can't use \headitemfont since the parsing differs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \the\everytab % for the first item
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% default for tables with no headings.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\headitemcrhook=\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% A \tab used to include \hskip1sp.  But then the space in a template
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% line is not enough.  That is bad.  So let's go back to just `&' until
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% we again encounter the problem the 1sp was intended to solve.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%					--karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newtoks\everytab  % insert after every tab.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\multitable{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vskip\parskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \startsavinginserts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\item{\crcr}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tolerance=9500
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hbadness=9500
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setmultitablespacing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parskip=\multitableparskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parindent=\multitableparindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \overfullrule=0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\colcount=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \everycr = {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \noalign{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \global\everytab={}% Reset from possible headitem.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Check for saved footnotes, etc.:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \checkinserts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Perhaps a \nobreak, then reset:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \headitemcrhook
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \global\let\headitemcrhook=\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parsearg\domultitable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\domultitable#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \halign\bgroup &%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\advance\colcount by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \multistrut
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \vtop{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % the first one.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % to the width of each template entry.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % will keep entries from bumping into each other.  Table will start at
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \rightskip=0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifnum\colcount=1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									% The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\advance\hsize by\leftskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\ifsetpercent \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									  % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									  % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									  \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % For example:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % @item @code{#}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % marking characters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }\cr
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Emultitable{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \crcr
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \egroup % end the \halign
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\setpercentfalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setmultitablespacing{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \multitableparskip calculation.  We used define \multistrut based on
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% table. If not, do nothing.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%        If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                                      % than skip between lines in the table.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                                      % than skip between lines in the table.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{conditionals,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @ifnotxml always succeed.  They currently do nothing; we don't
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested.  But we
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% attempt to close an environment group.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\makecond#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makecond{iftex}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makecond{ifnotdocbook}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makecond{ifnothtml}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makecond{ifnotinfo}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makecond{ifnotplaintext}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makecond{ifnotxml}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\html{\doignore{html}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% A count to remember the depth of nesting.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\doignorecount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doignore#1{\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \obeylines
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\@ = \other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\{ = \other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\} = \other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \spaceisspace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \doignorecount = 0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dodoignore{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{ \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \obeylines %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % line.  (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % And now expand that command.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \doignoretext ^^M%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doignoreyyy#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\empty			% Nothing found.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\next\doignoretextzzz
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else					% Found a nested condition, ...
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\doignorecount by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\next\doignoretextyyy		% ..., look for another.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\doignorecount = 0	% We have just found the outermost @end.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\next\enddoignore
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else				% Still inside a nested condition.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\doignorecount by -1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\next\doignoretext      % Look for the next @end.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Finish off ignored text.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{ \obeylines%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % would result in a blank line in the output.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% didn't need it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \makevalueexpandable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\temp{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\temp\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \next{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\clear{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \makevalueexpandable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\value = \expandablevalue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % We don't want these characters active, ...
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let-\normaldash \let_\normalunderscore
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\expandablevalue#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {[No value for ``#1'']}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \csname SET#1\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Like \expandablevalue, but completely expandable (the \message in the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% definition above operates at the execution level of TeX).  Used when
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% writing to auxiliary files, due to the expansion that \write does.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If flag is undefined, pass through an unexpanded @value command: maybe it
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% will be set by the time it is read back in.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% NB flag names containing - or _ may not work here.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dummyvalue#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \string\value{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \csname SET#1\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Used for @value's in index entries to form the sort key: expand the @value
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% if possible, otherwise sort late.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\indexnofontsvalue#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    ZZZZZZZ%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \csname SET#1\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% with @set.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% To get the special treatment we need for `@end ifset,' we call
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \makecond and then redefine.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makecond{ifset}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doifset#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \makevalueexpandable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\next=\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      #1% If not set, redefine \next.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }\next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @ifclear VAR ... @end executes the `...' iff VAR has never been
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makecond{ifclear}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @ifcommandisdefined CMD ... @end executes the `...' if CMD (written
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% without the @) is in fact defined.  We can only feasibly check at the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% TeX level, so something like `mathcode' is going to considered
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% defined even though it is not a Texinfo command.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makecond{ifcommanddefined}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifcommanddefined{\parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\let\next=\ifcmddefinedfail}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doifcmddefined#1#2{{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \makevalueexpandable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\next=\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\ifx\csname #2\endcsname\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      #1% If not defined, \let\next as above.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }\next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifcmddefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommanddefined}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @ifcommandnotdefined CMD ... handled similar to @ifclear above.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makecond{ifcommandnotdefined}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifcommandnotdefined{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\else \let\next=\ifcmdnotdefinedfail}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifcmdnotdefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommandnotdefined}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Set the `txicommandconditionals' variable, so documents have a way to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% test if the @ifcommand...defined conditionals are available.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\set txicommandconditionals
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @dircategory CATEGORY  -- specify a category of the dir file
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% which this file should belong to.  Ignore this in TeX.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\dircategory=\comment
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @defininfoenclose.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\definfoenclose=\comment
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{indexing,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Index generation facilities
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \newindex {foo} defines an index named IX.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% It automatically defines \IXindex such that
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \IXindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index IX.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% It also defines \IXindfile to be the number of the output channel for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the file that accumulates this index.  The file's extension is IX.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% for the sake of vms.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\newindex#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\chardef\csname#1indfile\endcsname=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%     % Define @#1index
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @defindex foo  ==  \newindex{foo}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\newcodeindex#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\chardef\csname#1indfile\endcsname=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The default indices:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newindex{cp}%      concepts,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcodeindex{fn}%  functions,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcodeindex{vr}%  variables,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcodeindex{tp}%  types,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcodeindex{ky}%  keys
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcodeindex{pg}%  and programs.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @synindex foo bar    makes index foo feed into index bar.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @syncodeindex foo bar   similar, but put all entries made for index foo
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% inside @code.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #3 the target index (bar).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \requireopenindexfile{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % redefine \fooindfile:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % redefine \fooindex:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define \doindex, the driver for all index macros.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and it is the two-letter name of the index.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\doindexxxx}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doindexxxx #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\docodeindexxxx}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\docodeindexxxx #1{\docind{\indexname}{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Used for the aux, toc and index files to prevent expansion of Texinfo
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% commands.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\atdummies{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyletter\@%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyletter\ %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyletter\{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyletter\}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyletter\&%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Do the redefinitions.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummies
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \otherbackslash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% preventing its expansion.  This is used only for control words,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% from whatever follows.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% those that do not.  If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% space.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\definedummyword  #1{\def#1{\string#1\space}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\definedummyletter#1{\def#1{\string#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Called from \atdummies to prevent the expansion of commands.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\definedummies{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\commondummyword\definedummyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\commondummyletter\definedummyletter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\commondummyaccent\definedummyaccent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummiesnofonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyletter\_%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyletter\-%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Non-English letters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\AA
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\AE
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\DH
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\L
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\O
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\OE
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\TH
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\aa
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\ae
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\dh
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\exclamdown
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\l
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\o
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\oe
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\ordf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\ordm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\questiondown
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\ss
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\th
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\bf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\gtr
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\hat
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\less
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\sf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\sl
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\tclose
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\tt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\LaTeX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\TeX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Assorted special characters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\ampchar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\atchar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\arrow
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\backslashchar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\bullet
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\comma
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\copyright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\dots
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\enddots
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\entrybreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\equiv
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\error
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\euro
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\expansion
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\geq
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\guillemetleft
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\guillemetright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\guilsinglright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\lbracechar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\leq
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\mathopsup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\minus
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\ogonek
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\pounds
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\point
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\print
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\quotedblbase
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\quotedblleft
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\quotedblright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\quoteleft
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\quoteright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\rbracechar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\result
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\sub
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\sup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\textdegree
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \definedummyword\subentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \macrolist
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\value\dummyvalue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \normalturnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \commondummiesnofonts: common to \definedummies and \indexnofonts.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define \commondummyletter, \commondummyaccent and \commondummyword before
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% using.  Used for accents, font commands, and various control letters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\commondummiesnofonts{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Control letters and accents.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyletter\!%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyaccent\"%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyaccent\'%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyletter\*%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyaccent\,%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyletter\.%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyletter\/%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyletter\:%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyaccent\=%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyletter\?%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyaccent\^%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyaccent\`%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyaccent\~%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\u
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\v
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\H
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\dotaccent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\ogonek
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\ringaccent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\tieaccent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\ubaraccent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\udotaccent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\dotless
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Texinfo font commands.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\b
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\i
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\r
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\sansserif
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\sc
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\slanted
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\t
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Commands that take arguments.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\abbr
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\acronym
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\anchor
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\cite
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\code
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\command
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\dfn
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\dmn
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\email
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\emph
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\env
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\file
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\image
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\indicateurl
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\inforef
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\kbd
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\key
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\math
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\option
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\pxref
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\ref
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\samp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\strong
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\tie
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\U
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\uref
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\url
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\var
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\verb
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\w
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummyword\xref
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\indexlbrace\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\indexrbrace\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\indexatchar\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\indexbackslash\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\catcode`\@=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\\=13
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @gdef@backslashdisappear{@def\{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\<=13
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\-=13
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\`=13
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\indexnonalnumdisappear{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlquoteignore\endcsname\relax\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % @set txiindexlquoteignore makes us ignore left quotes in the sort term.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % (Introduced for FSFS 2nd ed.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let`=\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexbackslashignore\endcsname\relax\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \backslashdisappear
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexhyphenignore\endcsname\relax\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def-{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlessthanignore\endcsname\relax\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def<{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexatsignignore\endcsname\relax\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\@{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\indexnonalnumreappear{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let-\normaldash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let<\normalless
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% by, and when constructing control sequence names.  It eliminates all
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% would be for a given command (usually its argument).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\indexnofonts{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Accent commands should become @asis.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\commondummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % We can just ignore other control letters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\commondummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % All control words become @asis by default; overrides below.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\commondummyword\commondummyaccent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \commondummiesnofonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %\let\tt=\asis
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\ { }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\@{@}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\-{}% @- shouldn't affect sorting
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \uccode`\1=`\{ \uppercase{\def\{{1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \uccode`\1=`\} \uppercase{\def\}{1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\lbracechar\{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\rbracechar\}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\do\indexnofontsdef
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Non-English letters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\AA{AA}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\AE{AE}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\DH{DZZ}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\L{L}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\OE{OE}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\O{O}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\TH{TH}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\aa{aa}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\ae{ae}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\dh{dzz}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\exclamdown{!}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\l{l}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\oe{oe}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\ordf{a}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\ordm{o}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\o{o}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\questiondown{?}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\ss{ss}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\th{th}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\TeX{TeX}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Assorted special characters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\atchar{@}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\arrow{->}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\bullet{bullet}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\comma{,}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\copyright{copyright}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\dots{...}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\enddots{...}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\equiv{==}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\error{error}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\euro{euro}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\expansion{==>}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\geq{>=}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\guillemetleft{<<}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\guillemetright{>>}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\guilsinglleft{<}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\guilsinglright{>}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\leq{<=}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\lbracechar{\{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\minus{-}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\point{.}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\pounds{pounds}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\print{-|}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\quotedblbase{"}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\quotedblleft{"}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\quotedblright{"}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\quoteleft{`}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\quoteright{'}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\quotesinglbase{,}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\rbracechar{\}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\registeredsymbol{R}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\result{=>}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\textdegree{o}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % that starts with \.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % to take a single TeX argument.  The case of a macro invocation that
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \macrolist
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\value\indexnofontsvalue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Give the control sequence a definition that removes the {} that follows
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% its use, e.g. @AA{} -> AA
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\indexnofontsdef#1#2{\def#1##1{#2}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doind#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \iflinks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \requireopenindexfile{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\indextext{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \safewhatsit\doindwrite
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Same as \doind, but for code indices
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\docind#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \iflinks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \requireopenindexfile{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\indextext{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \safewhatsit\docindwrite
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Check if an index file has been opened, and if not, open it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\requireopenindexfile#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifnum\csname #1indfile\endcsname=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\suffix{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % A .fls suffix would conflict with the file extension for the output
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % of -recorder, so use .f1s instead.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\suffix\indexisfl\def\suffix{f1}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Open the file
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \immediate\openout\csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.\suffix
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Using \immediate above here prevents an object entering into the current
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % box, which could confound checks such as those in \safewhatsit for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % preceding skips.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \typeout{Writing index file \jobname.\suffix}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\indexisfl{fl}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Definition for writing index entry sort key.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\-=13
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\indexwritesortas{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \indexnonalnumreappear
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \indexwritesortasxxx}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\indexwritesortasxxx#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \xdef\indexsortkey{#1}\endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\indexwriteseealso#1{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\pagenumbertext{\string\seealso{#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\indexwriteseeentry#1{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\pagenumbertext{\string\seeentry{#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The default definitions
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sortas#1{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\seealso#1{\i{\putwordSeeAlso}\ #1}% for sorted index file only
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\putwordSeeAlso{See also}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\seeentry#1{\i{\putwordSee}\ #1}% for sorted index file only
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Given index entry text like "aaa @subentry bbb @sortas{ZZZ}":
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   * Set \bracedtext to "{aaa}{bbb}"
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   * Set \fullindexsortkey to "aaa @subentry ZZZ"
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   * If @seealso occurs, set \pagenumbertext
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\splitindexentry#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\fullindexsortkey{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \xdef\bracedtext{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\sep{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\seealso##1{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\seeentry##1{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\doindexsegment#1\subentry\finish\subentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% append the results from the next segment
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doindexsegment#1\subentry{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\segment{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\segment\isfinish
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Fully expand the segment, throwing away any @sortas directives, and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % trim spaces.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \edef\trimmed{\segment}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \edef\trimmed{\expandafter\eatspaces\expandafter{\trimmed}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifincodeindex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \edef\trimmed{\noexpand\code{\trimmed}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \xdef\bracedtext{\bracedtext{\trimmed}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Get the string to sort by.  Process the segment with all
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % font commands turned off.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\sortas\indexwritesortas
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\seealso\indexwriteseealso
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\seeentry\indexwriteseeentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \indexnofonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % The braces around the commands are recognized by texindex.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\lbracechar{{\string\indexlbrace}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\rbracechar{{\string\indexrbrace}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\{=\lbracechar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\}=\rbracechar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\@{{\string\indexatchar}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\atchar##1{\@}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\backslashchar{{\string\indexbackslash}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \uccode`\~=`\\ \uppercase{\let~\backslashchar}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\indexsortkey\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \global\let\pagenumbertext\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Execute the segment and throw away the typeset output.  This executes
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % any @sortas or @seealso commands in this segment.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setbox\dummybox = \hbox{\segment}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifx\indexsortkey\empty{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \indexnonalnumdisappear
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \xdef\trimmed{\segment}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \xdef\trimmed{\expandafter\eatspaces\expandafter{\trimmed}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \xdef\indexsortkey{\trimmed}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifx\indexsortkey\empty\xdef\indexsortkey{ }\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Append to \fullindexsortkey.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \edef\tmp{\gdef\noexpand\fullindexsortkey{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  \fullindexsortkey\sep\indexsortkey}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \tmp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \egroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\sep{\subentry}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\doindexsegment
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\isfinish{\finish}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newbox\dummybox % used above
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\subentry\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Use \ instead of @ in index files.  To support old texi2dvi and texindex.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This works without changing the escape character used in the toc or aux
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% files because the index entries are fully expanded here, and \string uses
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the current value of \escapechar.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\escapeisbackslash{\escapechar=`\\}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Use \ in index files by default.  texi2dvi didn't support @ as the escape
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% character (as it checked for "\entry" in the files, and not "@entry").  When
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the new version of texi2dvi has had a chance to become more prevalent, then
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the escape character can change back to @ again.  This should be an easy
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% change to make now because both @ and \ are only used as escape characters in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% index files, never standing for themselves.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\set txiindexescapeisbackslash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Write the entry in \indextext to the index file.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifincodeindex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doindwrite{\incodeindexfalse\doindwritex}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\docindwrite{\incodeindextrue\doindwritex}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doindwritex{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \maybemarginindex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \atdummies
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexescapeisbackslash\endcsname\relax\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \escapeisbackslash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % For texindex which always views { and } as separators.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\{{\lbracechar{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\}{\rbracechar{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \uccode`\~=`\\ \uppercase{\def~{\backslashchar{}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Split the entry into primary entry and any subentries, and get the index
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % sort key.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \splitindexentry\indextext
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % the original text, including any font commands.  We write
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % sorted result.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\temp{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \write\writeto{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \string\entry{\fullindexsortkey}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {\ifx\pagenumbertext\empty\noexpand\folio\else\pagenumbertext\fi}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \bracedtext}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \temp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Put the index entry in the margin if desired (undocumented).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\maybemarginindex{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \relax\indextext}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\SETmarginindex=\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the skip again.  Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero.  The result is that
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% sequences like this:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @end defun
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @tindex whatever
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @defun ...
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the previous defun.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode.  We
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% But wait, there is a catch there:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip.  \ifdim is not
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% of the skip.  The only way seems to be to check the textual
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% representation of the skip.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\whatsitskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\whatsitpenalty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% ..., ready, GO:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\safewhatsit#1{\ifhmode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  #1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								 \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \whatsitskip = \lastskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % skip.  And since a skip is discardable, that means this
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \vskip-\whatsitskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  #1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak.  In that case, we want
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint.  For example:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %   @deffn deffn-whatever
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %   @vindex index-whatever
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %   Description.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % and the "Description." paragraph.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The index entry written in the file actually looks like
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%  \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% or
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%  \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% containing these kinds of lines:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%  \initial {c}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%     before the first topic whose initial is c
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%  \entry {topic}{pagelist}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%     for a topic that is used without subtopics
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%  \primary {topic}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%  \entry {topic}{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%     for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%  \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%     for each subtopic.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%  \secondary {subtopic}{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%     for a subtopic with sub-subtopics
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%  \tertiary {subtopic}{subsubtopic}{pagelist}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%     for each sub-subtopic.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define the user-accessible indexing commands
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\findex {\fnindex}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\kindex {\kyindex}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\cindex {\cpindex}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\vindex {\vrindex}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\tindex {\tpindex}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\pindex {\pgindex}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \smallfonts \rm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tolerance = 9500
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \plainfrenchspacing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % See comment in \requireopenindexfile.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\indexname{#1}\ifx\indexname\indexisfl\def\indexname{f1}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \openin 1 \jobname.\indexname s
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % index.  The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % there is some text.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \putwordIndexNonexistent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \typeout{No file \jobname.\indexname s.}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % false.  We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % it can discover if there is anything in it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \read 1 to \thisline
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \putwordIndexIsEmpty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\printindexzz\thisline\relax\relax\finish%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \closein 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If the index file starts with a backslash, forgo reading the index
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% file altogether.  If somebody upgrades texinfo.tex they may still have
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% old index files using \ as the escape character.  Reading this would
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% at best lead to typesetting garbage, at worst a TeX syntax error.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\printindexzz#1#2\finish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexescapeisbackslash\endcsname\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \uccode`\~=`\\ \uppercase{\if\noexpand~}\noexpand#1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiskipindexfileswithbackslash\endcsname\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\errmessage{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								ERROR: A sorted index file in an obsolete format was skipped.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								To fix this problem, please upgrade your version of 'texi2dvi'
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								or 'texi2pdf' to that at <https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo>.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								If you are using an old version of 'texindex' (part of the Texinfo
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								distribution), you may also need to upgrade to a newer version (at least 6.0).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								You may be able to typeset the index if you run
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								'texindex \jobname.\indexname' yourself.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								You could also try setting the 'txiindexescapeisbackslash' flag by
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								running a command like
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								'texi2dvi -t "@set txiindexescapeisbackslash" \jobname.texi'.  If you do
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								this, Texinfo will try to use index files in the old format.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								If you continue to have problems, deleting the index files and starting again
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								might help (with 'rm \jobname.?? \jobname.??s')%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        (Skipped sorted index file in obsolete format)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \begindoublecolumns
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \input \jobname.\indexname s
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \enddoublecolumns
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \begindoublecolumns
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \catcode`\\=0\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Make @ an escape character to give macros a chance to work.  This
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % should work because we (hopefully) don't otherwise use @ in index files.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %\catcode`\@=12\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \catcode`\@=0\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \input \jobname.\indexname s
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \enddoublecolumns
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Change them to control the appearance of the index.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\catcode`\/=13 \catcode`\-=13 \catcode`\^=13 \catcode`\~=13 \catcode`\_=13
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\|=13 \catcode`\<=13 \catcode`\>=13 \catcode`\+=13 \catcode`\"=13
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\$=3
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\initialglyphs{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % special control sequences used in the index sort key
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\indexlbrace\{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\indexrbrace\}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\indexatchar\@%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\indexbackslash{\math{\backslash}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Some changes for non-alphabetic characters.  Using the glyphs from the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % math fonts looks more consistent than the typewriter font used elsewhere
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % for these characters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \uccode`\~=`\\ \uppercase{\def~{\math{\backslash}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % In case @\ is used for backslash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \uppercase{\let\\=~}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Can't get bold backslash so don't use bold forward slash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\/=13
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def/{{\secrmnotbold \normalslash}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def-{{\normaldash\normaldash}}% en dash `--'
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def^{{\chapbf \normalcaret}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def~{{\chapbf \normaltilde}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\_{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def|{$\vert$}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def<{$\less$}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def>{$\gtr$}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def+{$\normalplus$}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\initial{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \initialglyphs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \initialx
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\initialx#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \removelastskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % The glue before the bonus allows a little bit of space at the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % bottom of a column to reduce an increase in inter-line spacing.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nobreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vskip 0pt plus 5\baselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \penalty -300
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vskip 0pt plus -5\baselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Typeset the initial.  Making this add up to a whole number of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % to column.  It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % we need before each entry, but it's better.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus 1\baselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \leftline{\secfonts \kern-0.05em \secbf #1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \secfonts is inside the argument of \leftline so that the change of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \baselineskip will not affect any glue inserted before the vbox that
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \leftline creates.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Do our best not to break after the initial.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nobreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \egroup % \initialglyphs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\entryrightmargin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\entryrightmargin=0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin.  It is used for index
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and table of contents entries.  The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\entry{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % affect previous text.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \par
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % No extra space above this paragraph.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \parskip = 0in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % When reading the text of entry, convert explicit line breaks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % from @* into spaces.  The user might give these in long section
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % titles, for instance.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\*{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\entrybreak{\hfil\break}% An undocumented command
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \afterassignment\doentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\temp =
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\entrybreak{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doentry{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Save the text of the entry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\setbox\boxA=\hbox\bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \noindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \aftergroup\finishentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % And now comes the text of the entry.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Not absorbing as a macro argument reduces the chance of problems
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % with catcodes occurring.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\catcode`\@=11
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\finishentry#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \egroup % end box A
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \dimen@ = \wd\boxA % Length of text of entry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\setbox\boxA=\hbox\bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \unhbox\boxA
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % #1 is the page number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Get the width of the page numbers, and only use
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % leaders if they are present.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \global\setbox\boxB = \hbox{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifdim\wd\boxB = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \null\nobreak\hfill\ %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifpdforxetex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \pdfgettoks#1.%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable\the\toksA
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable #1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \egroup % end \boxA
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifdim\wd\boxB = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \noindent\unhbox\boxA\par
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \nobreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % We want the text of the entries to be aligned to the left, and the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % page numbers to be aligned to the right.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \parindent = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fil
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus -1fill
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \rightskip = 0pt plus -1fil
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fill
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Cause last line, which could consist of page numbers on their own
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % if the list of page numbers is long, to be aligned to the right.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \parfillskip=0pt plus -1fill
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance\rightskip by \entryrightmargin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Determine how far we can stretch into the margin.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % This allows, e.g., "Appendix H  GNU Free Documentation License" to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % fit on one line in @letterpaper format.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifdim\entryrightmargin>2.1em
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \dimen@i=2.1em
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \dimen@i=0em
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance \parfillskip by 0pt minus 1\dimen@i
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \dimen@ii = \hsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance\dimen@ii by -1\leftskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance\dimen@ii by -1\entryrightmargin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance\dimen@ii by 1\dimen@i
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifdim\wd\boxA > \dimen@ii % If the entry doesn't fit in one line
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifdim\dimen@ > 0.8\dimen@ii   % due to long index text
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % Try to split the text roughly evenly.  \dimen@ will be the length of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % the first line.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \dimen@ = 0.7\dimen@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \dimen@ii = \hsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifnum\dimen@>\dimen@ii
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % If the entry is too long (for example, if it needs more than
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % two lines), use all the space in the first line.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \dimen@ = \dimen@ii
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill % ragged right
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \advance \dimen@ by 1\rightskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \parshape = 2 0pt \dimen@ 0em \dimen@ii
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % Ideally we'd add a finite glue at the end of the first line only,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % instead of using \parshape with explicit line lengths, but TeX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % doesn't seem to provide a way to do such a thing.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % Indent all lines but the first one.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \advance\leftskip by 1em
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \advance\parindent by -1em
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \indent % start paragraph
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \unhbox\boxA
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \finalhyphendemerits = 0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Word spacing - no stretch
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \spaceskip=\fontdimen2\font minus \fontdimen4\font
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \linepenalty=1000  % Discourage line breaks.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \hyphenpenalty=5000  % Discourage hyphenation.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \par % format the paragraph
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \egroup % The \vbox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\thinshrinkable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\skip\thinshrinkable=.15em minus .15em
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The filll stretch here overpowers both the fil and fill stretch to push
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the page number to the right.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1filll}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\secondary{\indententry{0.5cm}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\tertiary{\indententry{1cm}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\indententry#1#2#3{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \leftskip=#1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \entry{#2}{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \egroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\@=11  % private names
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newbox\partialpage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % If not much space left on page, start a new page.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifdim\pagetotal>0.8\vsize\vfill\eject\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Grab any single-column material above us.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \output = {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \savetopmark
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Unvbox the main output page.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \unvbox\PAGE
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \output = {\doublecolumnout}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Change the page size parameters.  We could do this once outside this
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % format, but then we repeat the same computation.  Repeating a couple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % the columns.  We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % changes automatically with the paper format.  The magic constant
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % as it did when we hard-coded it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % been clobbered.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % previous page.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\vsize by -\ht\partialpage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vsize = 2\vsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % For the benefit of balancing columns
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\baselineskip by 0pt plus 0.5pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the last, which is done by \balancecolumns.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doublecolumnout{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \savetopmark
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dimen@ = \vsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \divide\dimen@ by 2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox0=\vsplit\PAGE to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit\PAGE to\dimen@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\advance\vsize by 2\ht\partialpage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \onepageout\pagesofar % empty except for the first time we are called
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \unvbox\PAGE
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \penalty\outputpenalty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\pagesofar{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \unvbox\partialpage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hbox to\txipagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Finished with double columns.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\enddoublecolumns{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % _before_ we change the output routine.  This is necessary in the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % following situation:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % break occurs before the last section starts.  However, the last
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % fit on the page and has to be broken off.  Without the following
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % is wrong:  The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % the broken-off section in the recent contributions.  As soon as
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % break.  The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % goal.  When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % and the final section into the vbox of \txipageheight (see
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \penalty0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \output = {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Split the last of the double-column material.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \savetopmark
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \balancecolumns
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \eject % call the \output just set
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifdim\pagetotal=0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % want to call it again.  Therefore, reset \output to its normal
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % definition right away.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\output=\expandafter{\the\defaultoutput}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Leave the double-column material on the current page, no automatic
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % page break.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \box\balancedcolumns
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % the current page.  We're now back to normal single-column
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\vsize = \txipageheight %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \pagegoal = \txipageheight %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % We had some left-over material.  This might happen when \doublecolumnout
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % is called in \balancecolumns.  Try again.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\enddoublecolumns
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newbox\balancedcolumns
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setbox\balancedcolumns=\vbox{shouldnt see this}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Only called for the last of the double column material.  \doublecolumnout
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% does the others.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\balancecolumns{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox\PAGE}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dimen@ = \ht0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifdim\dimen@<7\baselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Don't split a short final column in two.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setbox2=\vbox{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\setbox\balancedcolumns=\vbox{\pagesofar}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % double the leading vertical space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\dimen@ by \topskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \dimen@ii = \dimen@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \splittopskip = \topskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Loop until left column is at least as high as the right column.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \vbadness = 10000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \loop
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \global\setbox3 = \copy0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifdim\ht1<\ht3
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \repeat
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Now the left column is in box 1, and the right column in box 3.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Check whether the left column has come out higher than the page itself.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % (Note that we have doubled \vsize for the double columns, so
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % the actual height of the page is 0.5\vsize).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifdim2\ht1>\vsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % It appears that we have been called upon to balance too much material.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Output some of it with \doublecolumnout, leaving the rest on the page.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setbox\PAGE=\box0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \doublecolumnout
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Compare the heights of the two columns.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifdim4\ht1>5\ht3
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % Column heights are too different, so don't make their bottoms
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % flush with each other.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \setbox2=\vbox to \ht1 {\unvbox3\vfill}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \setbox0=\vbox to \ht1 {\unvbox1\vfill}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % Make column bottoms flush with each other.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \setbox2=\vbox to\ht1{\unvbox3\unskip}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \setbox0=\vbox to\ht1{\unvbox1\unskip}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \global\setbox\balancedcolumns=\vbox{\pagesofar}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\@ = \other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{sectioning,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Chapters, sections, etc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Let's start with @part.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\outer\parseargdef\part{\partzzz{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\partzzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \chapoddpage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \null
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vskip.3\vsize  % move it down on the page a bit
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \noindent \titlefonts\rm #1\par % the text
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\lastnode=\empty      % no node to associate with
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \writetocentry{part}{#1}{}% but put it in the toc
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \headingsoff              % no headline or footline on the part page
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % This outputs a mark at the end of the page that clears \thischapter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % and \thissection, as is done in \startcontents.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\pchapsepmacro\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \chapmacro{}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \chapoddpage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \unnumberedno is an oxymoron.  But we count the unnumbered
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% outlines by their "section number".  We avoid collisions with chapter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% numbers by starting them at 10000.  (If a document ever has 10000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\chapno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\secno        \secno=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\subsecno     \subsecno=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\subsubsecno  \subsubsecno=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\appendixno  \appendixno = `\@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\appendixletter{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % expanded while writing the .toc file.  \char\appendixno is not
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\char\the\appendixno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and name of the chapter.  Page headings and footings can use
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% these.  @section does likewise.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\thischapter{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\thischapternum{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\thischaptername{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\thissection{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\thissectionnum{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\thissectionname{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% we only have subsub.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\chardef\maxseclevel = 3
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% To achieve this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\chardef\unnlevel = \maxseclevel
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\chapheadtype{N}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Choose a heading macro
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is heading type
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #2 is heading level
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #3 is text for heading
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\genhead#1#2#3{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Compute the abs. sec. level:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \absseclevel=#2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \absseclevel = 0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \absseclevel = 3
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % The heading type:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\headtype{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \if \headtype U%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum \absseclevel < \unnlevel
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \chardef\unnlevel = \absseclevel
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Check for appendix sections:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum \absseclevel > \unnlevel
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\headtype{U}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \chardef\unnlevel = 3
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Now print the heading:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \if \headtype U%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifcase\absseclevel
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\unnumberedzzz{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \if \headtype A%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifcase\absseclevel
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									  \appendixzzz{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifcase\absseclevel
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									  \chapterzzz{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \or \seczzz{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \suppressfirstparagraphindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% an interface:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\numhead{\genhead N}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\apphead{\genhead A}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered.  Increment top-level counter, reset
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (e.g., figures), q.v.  By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\chapterzzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % as an @include file.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\advance\chapno by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Used for \float.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \resetallfloatnos
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \putwordChapter can contain complex things in translations.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordChapter}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \message{\the\toks0 \space \the\chapno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Write the actual heading.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let\section = \numberedsec
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally calls appendixzzz
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\appendixzzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\advance\appendixno by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \resetallfloatnos
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \putwordAppendix can contain complex things in translations.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordAppendix}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \message{\the\toks0 \space \appendixletter}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let\section = \appendixsec
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \resetallfloatnos
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % argument to \message.  Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % expanded them.  For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % to be executed, not expanded).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself.  We use
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>.  (We also do this for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % the toc entries.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \toks0 = {#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \message{(\the\toks0)}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \unnmhead0{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @top is like @unnumbered.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\top\unnumbered
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Sections.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\seczzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\secno by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% normally calls appendixsectionzzz:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\secno by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\appendixsec\appendixsection
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% normally calls unnumberedseczzz:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\secno by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Subsections.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% normally calls numberedsubseczzz:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\subsecno by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% normally calls appendixsubseczzz:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\subsecno by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\subsecno by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Subsubsections.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% normally numberedsubsubseczzz:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                 {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% normally appendixsubsubseczzz:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% These macros control what the section commands do, according
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\section = \numberedsec
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\majorheading{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \suppressfirstparagraphindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\chapheadingskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Start a new page
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \chapoddpage - start on an odd page for a new chapter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong.  But we don't
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\chapoddpage{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \chappager
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifodd\pageno \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \headingsoff
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \null
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \chappager
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\setchapternewpage{\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\CHAPPAGoff{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsinglechapoff}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\CHAPPAGon{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\CHAPPAGodd{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\CHAPPAGon
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \chapmacro - Chapter opening.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Not used for @heading series.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% To test against our argument.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\ifx\thisenv\titlepage\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \checkenv{}% chapters, etc., should not start inside an environment.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\prevchapterdefs=\currentchapterdefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\prevsectiondefs=\currentsectiondefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\currentsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                        \gdef\thissection{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temptype{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \gdef\currentchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                          \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \gdef\currentchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                          \gdef\thischapter{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \toks0={#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \xdef\currentchapterdefs{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % \noexpand\putwordAppendix avoids expanding indigestible
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % commands in some of the translations.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordAppendix{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                                 \noexpand\thischapternum:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                                 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \toks0={#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \xdef\currentchapterdefs{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % \noexpand\putwordChapter avoids expanding indigestible
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % commands in some of the translations.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordChapter{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                                 \noexpand\thischapternum:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                                 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Output the mark.  Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % the preceding space.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \safewhatsit\domark
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Insert the chapter heading break.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \pchapsepmacro
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Now the second mark, after the heading break.  No break points
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % between here and the heading.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\prevchapterdefs=\currentchapterdefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\prevsectiondefs=\currentsectiondefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \domark
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \chapfonts \rm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading % give better error message
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Have to define \currentsection before calling \donoderef, because the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % xref code eventually uses it.  On the other hand, it has to be called
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \gdef\currentsection{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\toctype{unnchap}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\toctype{omit}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\toctype{app}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\toctype{numchap}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Write the toc entry for this chapter.  Must come before the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % been typeset.  If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \donoderef{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Typeset the actual heading.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \vbox{\raggedtitlesettings \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \unhbox0 #1\par}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nobreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\centerparameters{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \leftskip = \rightskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parfillskip = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Section titles.  These macros combine the section number parts and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\secheadingskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Subsection titles.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\subsecheadingskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Subsubsection titles.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Print any size, any type, section title.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is the text of the title,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec),
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #3 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc),
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #4 is the section number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\seckeyword{sec}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\temptype{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % It is ok for the @heading series commands to appear inside an
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % environment (it's been historically allowed, though the logic is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % dubious), but not the others.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \checkenv{}% non-@*heading should not be in an environment.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Switch to the right set of fonts.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\prevsectiondefs=\currentsectiondefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \gdef\currentsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                              \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Don't redefine \thissection.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \toks0={#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \xdef\currentsectiondefs{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % commands in some of the translations.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                                     \noexpand\thissectionnum:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                                     \noexpand\thissectionname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \toks0={#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \xdef\currentsectiondefs{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % commands in some of the translations.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                                     \noexpand\thissectionnum:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                                     \noexpand\thissectionname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Go into vertical mode.  Usually we'll already be there, but we
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % don't want the following whatsit to end up in a preceding paragraph
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % if the document didn't happen to have a blank line.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \par
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Output the mark.  Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % the preceding space.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \safewhatsit\domark
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Insert space above the heading.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Now the second mark, after the heading break.  No break points
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % between here and the heading.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\let\prevsectiondefs=\currentsectiondefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \domark
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\toctype{unn}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \gdef\currentsection{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % and don't redefine \currentsection.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\toctype{omit}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\sectionlevel=\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\toctype{app}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \gdef\currentsection{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\toctype{num}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \gdef\currentsection{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef).  See comments in \chapmacro.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \donoderef{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % \writetocentry if there was no node).  We don't want to allow that
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong.  Debian bug 276000.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nobreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Output the actual section heading.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \ptexraggedright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \hangindent=\wd0  % zero if no section number
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \unhbox0 #1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Don't allow stretch, though.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % was followed by glue.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nobreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % glue accumulate.  (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % discardable item.)  However, when a paragraph is not started next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % (\startdefun, \cartouche, \center, etc.), this needs to be wiped out
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % or the negative glue will cause weirdly wrong output, typically
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % obscuring the section heading with something else.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vskip-\parskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % This is so the last item on the main vertical list is a known
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \penalty > 10000, so \startdefun, etc., can recognize the situation
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % and do the needful.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \penalty 10001
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{toc,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Table of contents.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newwrite\tocfile
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Called from @chapter, etc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% read this.  The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% destination to jump to.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything.  This is used for the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% table of contents chapter openings themselves.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\iftocfileopened
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\omitkeyword{omit}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \iftocfileopened\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \global\tocfileopenedtrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \iflinks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {\atdummies
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \edef\temp{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \temp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % writing pdf.  These are used in the table of contents.  We can't
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % two pages of the document.  Thus, we'd have two destinations named
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % `1', and two named `2'.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifpdforxetex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% fonts, so we must take special care.  This is more or less redundant
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\activecatcodes{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\"=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\$=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\<=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\>=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\\=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\_=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\|=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\~=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\readtocfile{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setupdatafile
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \activecatcodes
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \input \tocreadfilename
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\savepageno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\startcontents#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % start on an odd page, unlike chapters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \contentsalignmacro
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \immediate\closeout\tocfile
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % It is abundantly clear what they are.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \savepageno = \pageno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup                  % Set up to handle contents files properly.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \raggedbottom              % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \entryrightmargin=\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Roman numerals for page numbers.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\thistitle{}% no title in double-sided headings
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Record where the Roman numerals started.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum\romancount=0 \global\romancount=\pagecount \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% redefined for the two-volume lispref.  We always output on
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Normal (long) toc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\contents{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifeof 1 \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \readtocfile
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \vfill \eject
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifeof 1 \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \pdfmakeoutlines
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \closein 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \contentsendroman
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% And just the chapters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\summarycontents{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\partentry = \shortpartentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \secfonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \rm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \hyphenpenalty = 10000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifeof 1 \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \readtocfile
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \closein 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \vfill \eject
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \contentsendroman
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Get ready to use Arabic numerals again
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\contentsendroman{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\pageno = \savepageno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % If \romancount > \arabiccount, the contents are at the end of the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % document.  Otherwise, advance where the Arabic numerals start for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % the page numbers.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\romancount>\arabiccount\else\global\arabiccount=\pagecount\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\shortchaplabel#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % But use \hss just in case.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % with appendix letters.  And right-justifying numbers and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % chapters.  Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % there are before deciding ...
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The first argument is the chapter or section name.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The last argument is the page number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Parts, in the main contents.  Replace the part number, which doesn't
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% exist, with an empty box.  Let's hope all the numbers have the same width.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Also ignore the page number, which is conventionally not printed.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\numeralbox{\setbox0=\hbox{8}\hbox to \wd0{\hfil}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\partentry#1#2#3#4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Add stretch and a bonus for breaking the page before the part heading.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % This reduces the chance of the page being broken immediately after the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % part heading, before a following chapter heading.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vskip 0pt plus 5\baselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \penalty-300
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vskip 0pt plus -5\baselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dochapentry{\numeralbox\labelspace#1}{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Parts, in the short toc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\shortpartentry#1#2#3#4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \penalty-300
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vskip.5\baselineskip plus.15\baselineskip minus.1\baselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \shortchapentry{{\bf #1}}{\numeralbox}{}{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Chapters, in the main contents.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Chapters, in the short toc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Appendices, in the main contents.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\appendixbox#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\hskip.7em#1}{#4}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Unnumbered chapters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Sections.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\appsecentry=\numsecentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Subsections.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% And subsubsections.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Same as \defaultparindent.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% page number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dochapentry#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     % Move the page numbers slightly to the right
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \advance\entryrightmargin by -0.05em
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \chapentryfonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\tocentry = \entry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{environments,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @foo ... @end foo.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @tex ... @end tex    escapes into raw TeX temporarily.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% But \@ or @@ will get a plain @ character.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\tex{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setupmarkupstyle{tex}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode `\%=14
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode `\+=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode `\"=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode `\|=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode `\<=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode `\>=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode `\`=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode `\'=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % ' is active in math mode (mathcode"8000).  So reset it, and all our
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % other math active characters (just in case), to plain's definitions.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \mathactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Inverse of the list at the beginning of the file.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\b=\ptexb
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\bullet=\ptexbullet
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\c=\ptexc
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\,=\ptexcomma
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\.=\ptexdot
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\dots=\ptexdots
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\equiv=\ptexequiv
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\!=\ptexexclam
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\i=\ptexi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\indent=\ptexindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\{=\ptexlbrace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\+=\tabalign
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\}=\ptexrbrace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\/=\ptexslash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\sp=\ptexsp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\*=\ptexstar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %\let\sup=\ptexsup % do not redefine, we want @sup to work in math mode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\t=\ptext
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter \let\csname top\endcsname=\ptextop  % we've made it outer
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\@{@}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% There is no need to define \Etex.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% such environments.  \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% have any width.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This space is always present above and below environments.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Make spacing and below environment symmetrical.  We use \parskip here
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\aboveenvbreak{{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \sectionheading, q.v.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgraf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \removelastskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % Penalize breaking before the environment, because preceding text
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % often leads into it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \penalty100
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \vskip\envskipamount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\afterenvbreak{{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \sectionheading, q.v.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgraf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \removelastskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % or better ...
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \vskip\envskipamount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \nonarrowing is a flag.  If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\nonarrowing=\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% environment contents.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \hskip\rskip}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \hskip\rskip}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% only require the font if @cartouche is actually used
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\cartouchefontdefs{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \font\circle=lcircle10\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\circthick
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\cartouche{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \cartouchefontdefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifhmode\par\fi  % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \startsavinginserts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \cartouter=\hsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt	% allow for 3pt kerns on either
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
												% side, and for 6pt waste from
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
												% each corner char, and rule thickness
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % If this cartouche directly follows a sectioning command, we need the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \parskip glue (backspaced over by default) or the cartouche can
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % collide with the section heading.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\lastpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \penalty\lastpenalty \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox\groupbox=\vbox\bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \carttop
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \hbox\bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									  \hskip\lskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									  \vrule\kern3pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									  \vbox\bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									      \kern3pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									      \hsize=\cartinner
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									      \baselineskip=\normbskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									      \lineskip=\normlskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									      \parskip=\normpskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									      \vskip -\parskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									      \comment % For explanation, see the end of def\group.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Ecartouche{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								              \ifhmode\par\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									      \kern3pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									  \egroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									  \kern3pt\vrule
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									  \hskip\rskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \egroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \cartbot
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \egroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \addgroupbox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \checkinserts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% inside a group.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\nonfillparindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\nonfillstart{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \aboveenvbreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifdim\hfuzz < 12pt \hfuzz = 12pt \fi % Don't be fussy
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parskip = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Turn off paragraph indentation but redefine \indent to emulate
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % the normal \indent.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nonfillparindent=\parindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parindent = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\indent\nonfillindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\nonarrowing = \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\obeyspaces
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We want to swallow spaces (but not other tokens) after the fake
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @indent in our nonfill-environments, where spaces are normally
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% active and set to @tie, resulting in them not being ignored after
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @indent.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\nonfillindent{\futurelet\temp\nonfillindentcheck}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\nonfillindentcheck{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\temp %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\expandafter\nonfillindentgobble%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\else%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\leavevmode\nonfillindentbox%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\nonfillindentgobble#1{\nonfillindent}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\nonfillindentbox{\hbox to \nonfillparindent{\hss}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This affects the following displayed environments:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%    @example, @display, @format, @lisp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\smallword{small}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\nosmallword{nosmall}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\SETdispenvsize\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setnormaldispenv{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % line.  This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % to change the fonts afterward.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \smallexamplefonts \rm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setsmalldispenv{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \smallexamplefonts \rm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Let's do it in one command.  #1 is the env name, #2 the definition.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\makedispenvdef#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define two environment synonyms (#1 and #2) for an environment.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\maketwodispenvdef#1#2#3{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \makedispenvdef{#1}{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \makedispenvdef{#2}{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font;
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @example: same as @lisp.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\maketwodispenvdef{lisp}{example}{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nonfillstart
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tt\setupmarkupstyle{example}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gobble % eat return
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedispenvdef{display}{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nonfillstart
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gobble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedispenvdef{format}{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\nonarrowing = t%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nonfillstart
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gobble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\flushleft{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\nonarrowing = t%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nonfillstart
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gobble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @flushright.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\flushright{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\nonarrowing = t%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nonfillstart
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gobble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @raggedright does more-or-less normal line breaking but no right
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% justification.  From plain.tex.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\raggedright{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \rightskip0pt plus2.4em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\Eraggedright\par
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\raggedleft{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parindent=0pt \leftskip0pt plus2em
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  % badness reporting.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\Eraggedleft\par
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\raggedcenter{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parindent=0pt \rightskip0pt plus1em \leftskip0pt plus1em
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                  % badness reporting.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\Eraggedcenter\par
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and narrows the margins.  We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% we're doing normal filling.  So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedispenvdef{quotation}{\quotationstart}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\quotationstart{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \indentedblockstart % same as \indentedblock, but increase right margin too.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parsearg\quotationlabel
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% doing normal filling.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Equotation{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \par
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\quotationauthor\thisisundefined\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % indent a bit.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Esmallquotation{\Equotation}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\quotationlabel#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\empty \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {\bf #1: }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @indentedblock is like @quotation, but indents only on the left and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% has no optional argument.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedispenvdef{indentedblock}{\indentedblockstart}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\indentedblockstart{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parindent=0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\nonarrowing = \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Keep a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're doing normal filling.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Eindentedblock{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \par
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Esmallindentedblock{\Eindentedblock}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command.  --janneke@gnu.org
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996.  The TeXbook.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% active too.  Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% verbatim line.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dospecials{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Don't do the quotes -- if we do, @set txicodequoteundirected and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % @set txicodequotebacktick will not have effect on @verb and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % @verbatim, and ?` and !` ligatures won't get disabled.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %\do\`\do\'%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% [Knuth] p. 380
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\uncatcodespecials{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Setup for the @verb command.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Eight spaces for a tab
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^I=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setupverb{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tt  % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setupmarkupstyle{verb}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tabeightspaces
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Respect line breaks,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % print special symbols as themselves, and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % make each space count
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % must do in this order:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Setup for the @verbatim environment
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Real tab expansion.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We typeset each line of the verbatim in an \hbox, so we can handle
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% tabs.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newbox\verbbox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\starttabbox{\setbox\verbbox=\hbox\bgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^I=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\tabexpand{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \catcode`\^^I=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \dimen\verbbox=\wd\verbbox % the width so far, or since the previous tab
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \divide\dimen\verbbox by\tabw
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \multiply\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance\dimen\verbbox by\tabw  % advance to next multiple of \tabw
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \wd\verbbox=\dimen\verbbox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \leavevmode\box\verbbox \starttabbox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% start the verbatim environment.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setupverbatim{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\nonarrowing = t%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nonfillstart
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\par{\egroup\leavevmode\box\verbbox\endgraf\starttabbox}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tabexpand
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setupmarkupstyle{verbatim}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Respect line breaks,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % print special symbols as themselves, and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % make each space count.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Must do in this order:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% delimiter characters.  Before first delimiter expect a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%    \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%     \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\ =\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \obeylines %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % of the @verbatim input line itself.  Otherwise we get an extra blank
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % line in the output.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \starttabbox#2\egroup\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % The \egroup ends the \verbbox started at the end of the last line in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % the block.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envdef\verbatim{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setnormaldispenv\setupverbatim\doverbatim
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \makevalueexpandable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setupverbatim
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \indexnofonts       % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @verbatiminclude of #1^^J}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \edef\tmp{\noexpand\input #1 }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }\expandafter\starttabbox\tmp\egroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \afterenvbreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @copying ... @end copying.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% possible is desirable.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\insertcopying{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \parindent = 0pt  % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \scanexp\copyingtext
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{defuns,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @defun etc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\defunpenalty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Start the processing of @deffn:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\startdefun{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \medbreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                        % following @def command, see below.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % which is there to keep the function description together with its
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % header.  But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % break somewhere.  Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % a break between a section heading and a defun.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % As a further refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % @def command.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % But do insert the glue.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \medskip  % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parindent=0in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dodefunx#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \checkenv#1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % It's not a great place, though.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\printdefunline#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % call \deffnheader:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    #1#2 \endheader
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % common ending:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \interlinepenalty = 10000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgraf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \penalty\defunpenalty  % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % rendering the following check redundant.  But we don't optimize.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \checkparencounts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\makedefun#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \temp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader { (defn. of \deffnheader) }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \envdef#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \startdefun
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \doingtypefnfalse    % distinguish typed functions from all else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def#3%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifdoingtypefn       % doing typed function?
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifrettypeownline    % typeset return type on its own line?
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @deftypefnnewline on|off says whether the return type of typed functions
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% are printed on their own line.  This affects @deftypefn, @deftypefun,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @deftypeop, and @deftypemethod.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\deftypefnnewline{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\onword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      = \empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\temp\offword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      = \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errhelp = \EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errmessage{Unknown @txideftypefnnl value `\temp',
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                must be on|off}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If SUBTOPIC is present, precede it with a space, and call \doind.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (At some time during the 20th century, this made a two-level entry in an
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% index such as the operation index.  Nobody seemed to notice the change in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% behaviour though.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\thirdarg{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\thirdarg\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \doind{#1}{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \doind{#1}{#2\space#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Untyped functions:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @deffn category name args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @deffn category class name args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \defopon {category on}class name args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Typed functions:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @deftypefn category type name args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @deftypeop category class type name args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \doingtypefntrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Typed variables:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @deftypevr category type var args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @deftypecv category class type var args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Untyped variables:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @defvr category var args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @defcv category class var args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \defcvof {category of}class var args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Types:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @deftp category name args
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is the category, such as "Function".
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #2 is the return type, if any.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #3 is the function name.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\defname#1#2#3{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \par
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Determine if we are typesetting the return type of a typed function
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % on a line by itself.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \rettypeownlinefalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifdoingtypefn  % doing a typed function specifically?
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % then check user option for putting return type on its own line:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname\relax \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \rettypeownlinetrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % How we'll format the category name.  Putting it in brackets helps
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % just below it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape.  We'll always have at
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % least two.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tempnum = 2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dimen0=\hsize  \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0  \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % If doing a return type on its own line, we'll have another line.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifrettypeownline
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\tempnum by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\maybeshapeline{0in \hsize}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\maybeshapeline{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % The continuations:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dimen2=\hsize  \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % The final paragraph shape:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parshape \tempnum  0in \dimen0  \maybeshapeline  \defargsindent \dimen2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Put the category name at the right margin.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \noindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hbox to 0pt{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \kern\leftskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %   common to leave accents off identifiers.  The result looks ok in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %   tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %   one has made identifiers using them :).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \df \tt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\temp{#2}% text of the return type
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\temp\empty\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \tclose{\temp}% typeset the return type
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifrettypeownline
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % put return type on its own line; prohibit line break following:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \hfil\vadjust{\nobreak}\break
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \space  % type on same line, so just followed by a space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi           % no return type
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    #3% output function name
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \rmfont
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \boldbrax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % arguments will be output next, if any.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% tt for the name.  This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% distinguishable.  Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\defunargs#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % use sl by default (not ttsl),
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % tt for the names.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % want a way to get ttsl.  We used to recommend @var for that, so
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % leave the code in, but it's strange for @var to lead to typewriter.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Nowadays we recommend @code, since the difference between a ttsl hyphen
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % and a tt hyphen is pretty tiny.  @code also disables ?` !`.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\var##1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var}\ttslanted{##1}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  #1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\activeparens{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\&=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc.  For example,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \activeparens
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let& = \&
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\ampchar\&
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\parencount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifampseen
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\ }}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\parenfont{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifampseen
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % At the first level, print parens in roman,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % otherwise use the default font.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % the contained text.  This is especially needed for [ and ] .
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \sf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\infirstlevel#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifampseen
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum\parencount=1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      #1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\opnr{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\advance\parencount by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\parenfont(}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \infirstlevel \bfafterword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\clnr{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\parenfont)}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \infirstlevel \sl
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\advance\parencount by -1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\brackcount
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\lbrb{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\advance\brackcount by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\bf[}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\rbrb{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {\bf]}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\advance\brackcount by -1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\checkparencounts{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\badparencount{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\parencount=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\badbrackcount{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\brackcount=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{macros,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @macro.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \newwrite\macscribble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\scantokens#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \toks0={#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \immediate\closeout\macscribble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \input \jobname.tmp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Used at the time of macro expansion.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Argument is macro body with arguments substituted
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\scanmacro#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \newlinechar`\^^M
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\xeatspaces{\eatspaces}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Process the macro body under the current catcode regime.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \scantokens{#1@comment}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % The \comment is to remove the \newlinechar added by \scantokens, and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % can be noticed by \parsearg.  Note \c isn't used because this means cedilla
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % in math mode.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Used for copying and captions
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\scanexp#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\scanmacro\expandafter{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\paramno   % Count of parameters
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newtoks\macname    % Macro name
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifrecursive  % Is it recursive?
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% List of all defined macros in the form
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%    \commondummyword\macro1\commondummyword\macro2...
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% if there is a need.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\macrolist{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Add the macro to \macrolist
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\commondummyword#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Utility routines.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%   \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (except of course we have to play expansion games).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\cslet#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \csname#2\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\catcode`\@=11
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\unbrace#1{#1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% to recognize macro arguments; this is the job of \mbodybackslash.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% them to avoid their expansion.  Must do this non-globally, to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% confine the change to the current group.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\scanctxt{% used as subroutine
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\"=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\+=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\<=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\>=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\_=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\|=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\~=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \passthroughcharstrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\scanargctxt{% used for copying and captions, not macros.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \scanctxt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\@=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\\=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^M=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\macrobodyctxt{% used for @macro definitions
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \scanctxt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\ =\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\@=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\{=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\}=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^M=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \usembodybackslash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Used when scanning braced macro arguments.  Note, however, that catcode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% changes here are ineffectual if the macro invocation was nested inside
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% an argument to another Texinfo command.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\macroargctxt{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \scanctxt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\ =\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\@=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^M=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\\=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\macrolineargctxt{% used for whole-line arguments without braces
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \scanctxt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\@=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\{=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\}=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% where N is the macro parameter number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								 @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								 @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\margbackslash#1{\char`\#1 }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\macroxxx#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\argl\empty       % no arguments
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \paramno=0\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \if\paramno>256\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         \errhelp = \EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         \errmessage{You need eTeX to compile a file with macros with more than 256 arguments}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\unmacro{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\commondummyword\unmacrodo
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro.  The idea is to omit any
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\unmacrodo#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx #1\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % remove this
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \noexpand\commondummyword \noexpand#1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \getargs -- Parse the arguments to a @macro line.  Set \macname to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the name of the macro, and \argl to the braced argument list.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\getmacname#1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This made use of the feature that if the last token of a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Parse the optional {params} list to @macro or @rmacro.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Set \paramno to the number of arguments,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and \paramlist to a parameter text for the macro (e.g. #1,#2,#3 for a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% three-param macro.)  Define \macarg.BLAH for each BLAH in the params
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% list to some hook where the argument is to be expanded.  If there are
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% less than 10 arguments that hook is to be replaced by ##N where N
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% is the position in that list, that is to say the macro arguments are to be
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% defined `a la TeX in the macro body.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used: see
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \parsemmanyargdef.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\parsemargdef#1;{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\hash\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \hash is redefined to `#' later to get it into definitions
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\xeatspaces\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parsemargdefxxx#1,;,%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\paramno<10\relax\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \paramno0\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \parsemmanyargdef@@#1,;,% 10 or more arguments
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \if#1;\let\next=\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\paramno by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\next}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \parsemacbody, \parsermacbody
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. (They're different since
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We are in \macrobodyctxt, and the \xdef causes backslashshes in the macro
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% body to be transformed.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Set \macrobody to the body of the macro, and call \defmacro.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\catcode`\ =\other\long\gdef\parsemacbody#1@end macro{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\xdef\macrobody{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\catcode`\ =\other\long\gdef\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\xdef\macrobody{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Make @ a letter, so that we can make private-to-Texinfo macro names.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\edef\texiatcatcode{\the\catcode`\@}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode `@=11\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%%%%%%%%%%%%% Code for > 10 arguments only   %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used, where the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% hook remains in the body, and when macro is to be expanded the body is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% processed again to replace the arguments.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% In that case, the hook is \the\toks N-1, and we simply set \toks N-1 to the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% argument N value and then \edef the body (nothing else will expand because of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the catcode regime under which the body was input).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If you compile with TeX (not eTeX), and you have macros with 10 or more
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% arguments, no macro can have more than 256 arguments (else error).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% In case that there are 10 or more arguments we parse again the arguments
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% list to set new definitions for the \macarg.BLAH macros corresponding to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% each BLAH argument. It was anyhow needed to parse already once this list
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% in order to count the arguments, and as macros with at most 9 arguments
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% are by far more frequent than macro with 10 or more arguments, defining
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% twice the \macarg.BLAH macros does not cost too much processing power.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\parsemmanyargdef@@#1,{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \if#1;\let\next=\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\next=\parsemmanyargdef@@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \edef\tempb{\eatspaces{#1}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\def\expandafter\tempa
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \expandafter{\csname macarg.\tempb\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Note that we need some extra \noexpand\noexpand, this is because we
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % don't want \the  to be expanded in the \parsermacbody  as it uses an
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % \xdef .
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\edef\tempa
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {\noexpand\noexpand\noexpand\the\toks\the\paramno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\paramno by 1\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\next}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\endargs@\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\nil@\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\nilm@{\nil@}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\long\def\nillm@{\nil@}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This macro is expanded during the Texinfo macro expansion, not during its
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% definition.  It gets all the arguments' values and assigns them to macros
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% macarg.ARGNAME
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is the macro name
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #2 is the list of argument names
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #3 is the list of argument values
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\getargvals@#1#2#3{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\macargdeflist@{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\saveparamlist@{#2}% Need to keep a copy for parameter expansion.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\paramlist{#2,\nil@}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\macroname{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \macroargctxt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\argvaluelist{#3,\nil@}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\@tempa{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\@tempa\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setemptyargvalues@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \getargvals@@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\getargvals@@{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Some sanity check needed here that \argvaluelist is also empty.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \errhelp = \EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \errmessage{Too many arguments in macro `\macroname'!}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % No more arguments values passed to macro.  Set remaining named-arg
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % macros to empty.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % pop current arg name into \@tempb
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\@tempa##1{\pop@{\@tempb}{\paramlist}##1\endargs@}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\paramlist}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % pop current argument value into \@tempc
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\@tempa##1{\longpop@{\@tempc}{\argvaluelist}##1\endargs@}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\argvaluelist}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % Here \@tempb is the current arg name and \@tempc is the current arg value.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % First place the new argument macro definition into \@tempd
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \expandafter\macname\expandafter{\@tempc}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \expandafter\let\csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempe\expandafter{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         \csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \edef\@tempd{\long\def\@tempe{\the\macname}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \push@\@tempd\macargdeflist@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \let\next\getargvals@@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\push@#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\def
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter#2%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter#1#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Replace arguments by their values in the macro body, and place the result
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% in macro \@tempa.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\macvalstoargs@{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %  To do this we use the property that token registers that are \the'ed
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % within an \edef  expand only once. So we are going to place all argument
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % values into respective token registers.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % First we save the token context, and initialize argument numbering.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \paramno0\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Then, for each argument number #N, we place the corresponding argument
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % value into a new token list register \toks#N
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\putargsintokens@\saveparamlist@,;,%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Then, we expand the body so that argument are replaced by their
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % values. The trick for values not to be expanded themselves is that they
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % are within tokens and that tokens expand only once in an \edef .
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \edef\@tempc{\csname mac.\macroname .body\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Now we restore the token stack pointer to free the token list registers
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % which we have used, but we make sure that expanded body is saved after
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % group.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\@tempc}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define the named-macro outside of this group and then close this group.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\macargexpandinbody@{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \macargdeflist@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % First the replace in body the macro arguments by their values, the result
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % is in \@tempa .
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \macvalstoargs@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Then we point at the \norecurse or \gobble (for recursive) macro value
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % with \@tempb .
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempb\csname mac.\macroname .recurse\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Depending on whether it is recursive or not, we need some tailing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \egroup .
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\@tempb\gobble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \let\@tempc\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \let\@tempc\egroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % And now we do the real job:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\@tempd{\noexpand\@tempb{\macroname}\noexpand\scanmacro{\@tempa}\@tempc}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \@tempd
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\putargsintokens@#1,{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \if#1;\let\next\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\next\putargsintokens@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % First we allocate the new token list register, and give it a temporary
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % alias \@tempb .
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \toksdef\@tempb\the\paramno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Then we place the argument value into that token list register.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempa\csname macarg.#1\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\@tempb\expandafter{\@tempa}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\paramno by 1\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Trailing missing arguments are set to empty.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setemptyargvalues@{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\setemptyargvaluesparser@\paramlist\endargs@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setemptyargvaluesparser@#1,#2\endargs@{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\def\csname macarg.#1\endcsname{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \push@\@tempa\macargdeflist@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\paramlist{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is the element target macro
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #2 is the list macro
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #3,#4\endargs@ is the list value
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\pop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \def#1{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \def#2{#4}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\long\def\longpop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \long\def#1{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \long\def#2{#4}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%%%%%%%%%%%%% End of code for > 10 arguments %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This defines a Texinfo @macro or @rmacro, called by \parsemacbody.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%    \macrobody has the body of the macro in it, with placeholders for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% its parameters, looking like "\xeatspaces{\hash 1}".
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%    \paramno is the number of parameters
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%    \paramlist is a TeX parameter text, e.g. "#1,#2,#3,"
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% There are four cases: macros of zero, one, up to nine, and many arguments.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% they're defined in: @include reads the file inside a group.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\defmacro{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\paramno=1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\xeatspaces##1{##1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % This removes the pair of braces around the argument.  We don't
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % use \eatspaces, because this can cause ends of lines to be lost
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % when the argument to \eatspaces is read, leading to line-based
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % commands like "@itemize" not being read correctly.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\xeatspaces\relax % suppress expansion
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifcase\paramno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % 0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \noexpand\spaceisspace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \noexpand\endlineisspace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \noexpand\expandafter % skip any whitespace after the macro name.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \egroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \or % 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \noexpand\braceorline
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname##1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \egroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else % at most 9
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum\paramno<10\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % @MACNAME sets the context for reading the macro argument
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % @MACNAME@@ gets the argument, processes backslashes and appends a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % comma.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % @MACNAME@@@ removes braces surrounding the argument list.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % @MACNAME@@@@ scans the macro body with arguments substituted.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \noexpand\expandafter  % This \expandafter skip any spaces after the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \noexpand\macroargctxt % macro before we change the catcode of space.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \noexpand\expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@\endcsname##1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \noexpand\passargtomacro
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname{##1,}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname##1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname ##1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\xdef
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname\paramlist{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else % 10 or more:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\macrobody
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\gobble
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode `\@\texiatcatcode\relax % end private-to-Texinfo catcodes
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=13  % We need to manipulate \ so use @ as escape
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@catcode`@_=11  % private names
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@catcode`@!=11  % used as argument separator
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \passargtomacro#1#2 -
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Call #1 with a list of tokens #2, with any doubled backslashes in #2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% compressed to one.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This implementation works by expansion, and not execution (so we cannot use
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \def or similar).  This reduces the risk of this failing in contexts where
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% complete expansion is done with no execution (for example, in writing out to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% an auxiliary file for an index entry).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% State is kept in the input stream: the argument passed to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @look_ahead, @gobble_and_check_finish and @add_segment is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT ! {PENDING_BS} NEXT_TOKEN  (... rest of input)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% where:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% THE_MACRO - name of the macro we want to call
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% ARG_RESULT - argument list we build to pass to that macro
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% PENDING_BS - either a backslash or nothing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% NEXT_TOKEN - used to look ahead in the input stream to see what's coming next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@gdef@passargtomacro#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @add_segment #1!{}@relax#2\@_finish\%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@gdef@_finish{@_finishx} @global@let@_finishx@relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #2 - PENDING_BS
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #4 used to look ahead
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If the next token is not a backslash, process the rest of the argument;
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% otherwise, remove the next token.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@gdef@look_ahead#1!#2#3#4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @ifx#4\%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @expandafter@gobble_and_check_finish
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @expandafter@add_segment
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @fi#1!{#2}#4#4%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #2 - PENDING_BS
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #4 should be a backslash, which is gobbled.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #5 looks ahead
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Double backslash found.  Add a single backslash, and look ahead.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@gdef@gobble_and_check_finish#1!#2#3#4#5{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @add_segment#1\!{}#5#5%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@gdef@is_fi{@fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #2 - PENDING_BS
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #4 is input stream until next backslash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Input stream is either at the start of the argument, or just after a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% backslash sequence, either a lone backslash, or a doubled backslash.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% NEXT_TOKEN contains the first token in the input stream: if it is \finish,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% finish; otherwise, append to ARG_RESULT the segment of the argument up until
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the next backslash.  PENDING_BACKSLASH contains a backslash to represent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% a backslash just before the start of the input stream that has not been
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% added to ARG_RESULT.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@gdef@add_segment#1!#2#3#4\{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@ifx#3@_finish
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @call_the_macro#1!%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % append the pending backslash to the result, followed by the next segment
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @expandafter@is_fi@look_ahead#1#2#4!{\}@fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % this @fi is discarded by @look_ahead.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % we can't get rid of it with \expandafter because we don't know how
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % long #4 is.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 - THE_MACRO
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #2 - ARG_RESULT
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #3 discards the res of the conditional in @add_segment, and @is_fi ends the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% conditional.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@gdef@call_the_macro#1#2!#3@fi{@is_fi #1{#2}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \braceorline MAC is used for a one-argument macro MAC.  It checks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% whether the next non-whitespace character is a {.  It sets the context
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% for reading the argument (slightly different in the two cases).  Then,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% to read the argument, in the whole-line case, it then calls the regular
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \parsearg MAC; in the lbrace case, it calls \passargtomacro MAC.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\braceorlinexxx{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\nchar\bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \macroargctxt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\passargtomacro
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \macrolineargctxt\expandafter\parsearg
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi \macnamexxx}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @alias.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% sign.  Make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \addtomacrolist{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{cross references,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newwrite\auxfile
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifhavexrefs    % True if xref values are known.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifwarnedxrefs  % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @inforef is relatively simple.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% cross-references.  The @node line might or might not have commas, and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @node foo , bar , ...
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @node Help-Cross,  ,  , Cross-refs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}\omittopnode}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Used so that the @top node doesn't have to be wrapped in an @ifnottex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% conditional.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \doignore goes to more effort to skip nested conditionals but we don't need
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% that here.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\omittopnode{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \ifx\lastnode\wordTop
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \expandafter\ignorenode\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\wordTop{Top}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Until the next @node or @bye command, divert output to a box that is not
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% output.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ignorenode{\setbox\dummybox\vbox\bgroup\def\node{\egroup\node}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ignorenodebye
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\let\bye\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\ignorenodebye{\let\bye\ignorenodebyedef}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\ignorenodebyedef{\egroup(`Top' node ignored)\bye}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The redefinition of \bye here is because it is declared \outer
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\lastnode=\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Write a cross-reference definition for the current node.  #1 is the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\donoderef#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\let\lastnode=\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\savesfregister
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% anchor), which consists of three parts:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \currentsection,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%                 or the anchor name.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% 2) NAME-snt   - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%                 empty for anchors.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% 3) NAME-pg    - the page number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat.  In the case of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% 4) NAME-lof   - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setref#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \pdfmkdest{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \iflinks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \requireauxfile
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \atdummies  % preserve commands, but don't expand them
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % match definition in \xrdef, \refx, \xrefX.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\value##1{##1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									\write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
									  ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \toks0 = \expandafter{\currentsection}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, at \shipout
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @xrefautosectiontitle on|off says whether @section(ing) names are used
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% automatically in xrefs, if the third arg is not explicitly specified.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This was provided as a "secret" @set xref-automatic-section-title
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% variable, now it's official.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\xrefautomaticsectiontitle{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\onword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      = \empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else\ifx\temp\offword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      = \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errhelp = \EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errmessage{Unknown @xrefautomaticsectiontitle value `\temp',
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                must be on|off}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references.  For \xrefX, #1 is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% manual.  All but the node name can be omitted.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\pxref{\putwordsee{} \xrefXX}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\xref{\putwordSee{} \xrefXX}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ref{\xrefXX}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\xrefXX#1{\def\xrefXXarg{#1}\futurelet\tokenafterxref\xrefXXX}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\xrefXXX{\expandafter\xrefX\expandafter[\xrefXXarg,,,,,,,]}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newbox\toprefbox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newbox\printedrefnamebox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newbox\infofilenamebox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newbox\printedmanualbox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \unsepspaces
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Get args without leading/trailing spaces.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox\printedrefnamebox = \hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\infofilename{\ignorespaces #4}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox\infofilenamebox = \hbox{\infofilename\unskip}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox\printedmanualbox  = \hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % If the printed reference name (arg #3) was not explicitly given in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % the @xref, figure out what we want to use.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifdim \wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % No printed node name was explicitly given.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Not auto section-title: use node name inside the square brackets.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Auto section-title: use chapter/section title inside
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % the square brackets if we have it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % It is in another manual, so we don't have it; use node name.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifhavexrefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % We (should) know the real title if we have the xref values.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \fi%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Make link in pdf output.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifpdf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % For pdfTeX and LuaTeX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {\indexnofonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \makevalueexpandable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \turnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     % etc. don't get their TeX definitions.  This ignores all spaces in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \getfilename{#4}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     % spaces in #1, which should be ignored.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \setpdfdestname{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \def\pdfdestname{Top}% no empty targets
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \leavevmode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \ifnum\filenamelength>0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfdestname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfdestname}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % For XeTeX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {\indexnofonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \makevalueexpandable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \turnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % etc. don't get their TeX definitions.  This ignores all spaces in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \getfilename{#4}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % spaces in #1, which should be ignored.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \setpdfdestname{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         \def\pdfdestname{Top}% no empty targets
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \leavevmode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \ifnum\filenamelength>0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         % With default settings,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         % XeTeX (xdvipdfmx) replaces link destination names with integers.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         % In this case, the replaced destination names of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         % remote PDFs are no longer known.  In order to avoid a replacement,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         % you can use xdvipdfmx's command line option `-C 0x0010'.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         % If you use XeTeX 0.99996+ (TeX Live 2016+),
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         % this command line option is no longer necessary
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         % because we can use the `dvipdfmx:config' special.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0] /Type /Annot /Subtype /Link /A
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								           << /S /GoToR /F (\the\filename.pdf) /D (\pdfdestname) >> >>}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0] /Type /Annot /Subtype /Link /A
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								           << /S /GoTo /D (\pdfdestname) >> >>}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \indexnofonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \turnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\value##1{##1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % instead of "[somenode], p.3".  \iffloat distinguishes them by
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \Xthisreftitle being set to a magic string.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifdim\wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \refx{#1-snt}{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \printedrefname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % If the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % "in MANUALNAME".
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % node/anchor (non-float) references.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % If we use \unhbox to print the node names, TeX does not insert
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will not
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % find a line break at a hyphen in a node names.  Since some manuals
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % this is a loss.  Therefore, we give the text of the node name
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % again, so it is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Cross-manual reference with a printed manual name.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \crossmanualxref{\cite{\printedmanual\unskip}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ifdim \wd\infofilenamebox > 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Cross-manual reference with only an info filename (arg 4), no
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % printed manual name (arg 5).  This is essentially the same as
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % the case above; we output the filename, since we have nothing else.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \crossmanualxref{\code{\infofilename\unskip}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Reference within this manual.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % output the `[mynode]' via the macro below so it can be overridden.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % But we always want a comma and a space:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      ,\space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % output the `page 3'.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Add a , if xref followed by a space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \if\space\noexpand\tokenafterxref ,%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else\ifx\	\tokenafterxref ,% @TAB
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else\ifx\*\tokenafterxref ,%   @*
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else\ifx\ \tokenafterxref ,%   @SPACE
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else\ifx\
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                \tokenafterxref ,%    @NL
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else\ifx\tie\tokenafterxref ,% @tie
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endlink
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Output a cross-manual xref to #1.  Used just above (twice).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Only include the text "Section ``foo'' in" if the foo is neither
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% missing or Top.  Thus, @xref{,,,foo,The Foo Manual} outputs simply
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% "see The Foo Manual", the idea being to refer to the whole manual.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% But, this being TeX, we can't easily compare our node name against the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% string "Top" while ignoring the possible spaces before and after in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the input.  By adding the arbitrary 7sp below, we make it much less
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% likely that a real node name would have the same width as "Top" (e.g.,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% in a monospaced font).  Hopefully it will never happen in practice.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For the same basic reason, we retypeset the "Top" at every
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% reference, since the current font is indeterminate.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\crossmanualxref#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox\toprefbox = \hbox{Top\kern7sp}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \printedrefname \unskip \kern7sp}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifdim \wd2 > 7sp  % nonempty?
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifdim \wd2 = \wd\toprefbox \else  % same as Top?
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{}\space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  #1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% output.  It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% since square brackets don't work well in some documents.  Particularly
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% one that Bob is working on :).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Things referred to by \setref.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Ynothing{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Yomitfromtoc{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Ynumbered{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\secno=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Yappendix{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifnum\secno=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \putwordSection@tie
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} - reference a cross-reference string named NAME.  SUFFIX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% is output afterwards if non-empty.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\refx#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \requireauxfile
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \indexnofonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \turnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\value##1{##1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \csname XR#1\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\thisrefX\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % If not defined, say something at least.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \iflinks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifhavexrefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        {\toks0 = {#1}% avoid expansion of possibly-complex value
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `\the\toks0'.}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifwarnedxrefs\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \global\warnedxrefstrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % It's defined, so just use it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \thisrefX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  #2% Output the suffix in any case.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file.  Define a control
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% sequence for a cross-reference target (we prepend XR to the control sequence
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% name to avoid collisions).  The value is the page number.  If this is a float
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% type, we have more work to do.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\xrdef#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {% Expand the node or anchor name to remove control sequences.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   % \turnoffactive stops 8-bit characters being changed to commands
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   % like @'e.  \refx does the same to retrieve the value in the definition.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \indexnofonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \turnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\value##1{##1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \egroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % We put the \gdef inside a group to avoid the definitions building up on
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % TeX's save stack, which can cause it to run out of space for aux files with
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % thousands of lines.  \gdef doesn't use the save stack, but \csname does
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % when it defines an unknown control sequence as \relax.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % for later use in \listoffloats.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {\safexrefname}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This is done with @novalidate at the beginning of the file.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\novalidate = \linksfalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Used when writing to the aux file, or when using data from it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\requireauxfile{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \iflinks
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \tryauxfile
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Open the new aux file.  TeX will close it automatically at exit.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\let\requireauxfile=\relax   % Only do this once.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Read the last existing aux file, if any.  No error if none exists.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\tryauxfile{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \openin 1 \jobname.aux
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifeof 1 \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \readdatafile{aux}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\havexrefstrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \closein 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setupdatafile{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^@=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^A=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^B=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^C=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^D=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^E=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^F=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^G=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^H=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^K=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^L=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^N=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^P=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^Q=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^R=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^S=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^T=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^U=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^V=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^W=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^X=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^Z=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^[=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^\=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^]=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^^=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^_=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Special characters.  Should be turned off anyway, but...
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\~=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\[=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\]=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\"=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\_=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\|=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\<=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\>=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\$=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\#=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\&=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\%=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\\=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\{=1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\}=2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\@=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\readdatafile#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setupdatafile
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \input\jobname.#1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{insertions,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% including footnotes.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount \footnoteno
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @footnotestyle is meaningful for Info output only.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\footnotestyle=\comment
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\catcode `\@=11
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Auto-number footnotes.  Otherwise like plain.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\footnote{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\@sf\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \unskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \thisfootno\@sf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dofootnote
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% footnote text as a parameter.  Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the footnote is read.  --karl, 16nov96.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\dofootnote{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \insert\footins\bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Nested footnotes are not supported in TeX, that would take a lot
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % more work.  (\startsavinginserts does not suffice.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\footnote=\errfootnotenest
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % So reset some parameters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hsize=\txipagewidth
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \floatingpenalty\@MM
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \leftskip\z@skip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \rightskip\z@skip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \spaceskip\z@skip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \xspaceskip\z@skip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parindent\defaultparindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \smallfonts \rm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op.  makeinfo does not use
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\noindent = \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Hang the footnote text off the number.  Use \everypar in case the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \everypar = {\hang}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \textindent{\thisfootno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text.  Since this
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \footstrut
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Invoke rest of plain TeX footnote routine.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \futurelet\next\fo@t
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}%end \catcode `\@=11
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\errfootnotenest{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \errhelp=\EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \errmessage{Nested footnotes not supported in texinfo.tex,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    even though they work in makeinfo; sorry}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\errfootnoteheading{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \errhelp=\EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \errmessage{Footnotes in chapters, sections, etc., are not supported}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the real \insert just after the vbox finished.  Otherwise, the insertion
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% would be lost.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% And the same can be done for other insert classes.  --kasal, 16nov03.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% out prematurely.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\startsavinginserts{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\insert\saveinsert
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\checkinserts\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\saveinsert#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \afterassignment\next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % swallow the left brace
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\temp =
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\placesaveins#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    {\box#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials  %  ;-)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% initialization:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\newsaveins #1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \next
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\newsaveinsX #1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \checksaveins #1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% initialize:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\checkinserts\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newsaveins\footins
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newsaveins\margin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @image.  We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Check for and read epsf.tex up front.  If we read it only at @image
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% undone and the next image would fail.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\openin 1 = epsf.tex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifeof 1 \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \input epsf.tex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\closein 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifwarnednoepsf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  work.  It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  it from https://ctan.org/texarchive/macros/texinfo/texinfo/doc/epsf.tex.}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\image#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\epsfbox\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifwarnednoepsf \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \errhelp = \noepsfhelp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \global\warnednoepsftrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Arguments to @image:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing stuff.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifimagevmode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\^^M = 5     % in case we're inside an example
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \normalturnoffactive  % allow _ et al. in names
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\xprocessmacroarg{\eatspaces}% in case we are being used via a macro
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % If the image is by itself, center it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifvmode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \imagevmodetrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else \ifx\centersub\centerV
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % for @center @image, we need a vbox so we can have our vertical space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \imagevmodetrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \vbox\bgroup % vbox has better behavior than vtop herev
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifimagevmode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nobreak\medskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % above and below.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nobreak\vskip\parskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \nobreak
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %  environment such as @quotation is respected.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % However, if we're at the top level, we don't want the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %  normal paragraph indentation.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % On the other hand, if we are in the case of @center @image, we don't
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %  want to start a paragraph, which will create a hsize-width box and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %  eradicate the centering.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\centersub\centerV\else \noindent \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Output the image.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifpdf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % For pdfTeX and LuaTeX <= 0.80
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % For epsf.tex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % For XeTeX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \doxeteximage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifimagevmode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \medskip  % space after a standalone image
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\centersub\centerV \egroup \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% etc.  We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% float "here".  But it seemed the best name for the future.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc.  Can't contain commas.  If omitted,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #2 is the optional xref label.  Also must be present for the float to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% be referable.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored.  It
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% chapter-level command.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\thiscaption=\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \startsavinginserts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \par
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vtop\bgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\floattype{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\floatlabel{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\floattype\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\safefloattype=\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \indexnofonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \turnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Table 1, Figure 2, ...).  (And if no label, no number.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \global\advance\floatno by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % This magic value for \currentsection is output by \setref as the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % XREFLABEL-title value.  \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % node and anchor labels.  And \xrdef uses it to construct the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        % lists of floats.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \edef\currentsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \vskip\parskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \restorefirstparagraphindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% we have these possibilities:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @float Foo,lbl & no caption:    Foo 1.1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @float Foo & @caption{Cap}:     Foo: Cap
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @float Foo & no caption:        Foo
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}:     1.1: Cap
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @float ,lbl & no caption:       1.1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @float & @caption{Cap}:         Cap
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @float & no caption:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Efloat{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\floatident = \empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % the number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let\captionline = \floatident
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifx\floatident\empty \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % caption text.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\captionline\empty \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \vskip.5\parskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \captionline
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Space below caption.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \vskip\parskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info.  Do this
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % \floatlabel-lof.  Besides \floatident, we include the short
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \requireauxfile
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \atdummies
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \def\gtemp{\thiscaption}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \def\gtemp{\thisshortcaption}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \egroup  % end of \vtop
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \checkinserts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @caption, @shortcaption
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% going to use.  Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\getfloatno#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx#1\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Haven't seen this figure type before.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\floatno#1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value.  We want an @xref
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1".  We call \setref when we
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% first read the @float command.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% distinguish floats from other xref types.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% which is true if #1 represents a float ref.  That is, the magic
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \currentsection value which we \setref above.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string.  If so, #2 will be the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (safe) float type for this float.  We set \iffloattype to #2.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\temp{#1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\iffloattype{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\temp\floatmagic
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\listoffloats{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  {%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \indexnofonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \turnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifhavexrefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \leftskip=\tocindent  % indent these entries like a toc
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This is called on each entry in a list of floats.  We're passed the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% aux file.  We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% they won't appear in the aux file).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything.  Just
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % pass the control sequence.  On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % in pdf output.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \writeentry
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{localization,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For single-language documents, @documentlanguage is usually given very
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% early, just after @documentencoding.  Single argument is the language
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (de) or locale (de_DE) abbreviation.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\_ = \active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \globaldefs=1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\documentlanguage{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \let_ = \normalunderscore  % normal _ character for filename test
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore #1_\finish
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \globaldefs = 1  % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \input txi-#1.tex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \closein 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup % end raw TeX
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% try txi-de.tex.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifeof 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errhelp = \nolanghelp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \globaldefs = 1  % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \input txi-#1.tex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \closein 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}% end of special _ catcode
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								is empty.  Maybe you need to install it?  Putting it in the current
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								directory should work if nowhere else does.}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This macro is called from txi-??.tex files; the first argument is the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \language name to set (without the "\lang@" prefix), the second and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% third args are \{left,right}hyphenmin.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% The language names to pass are determined when the format is built.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% See the etex.log file created at that time, e.g.,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% /usr/local/texlive/2008/texmf-var/web2c/pdftex/etex.log.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% With TeX Live 2008, etex now includes hyphenation patterns for all
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% available languages.  This means we can support hyphenation in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Texinfo, at least to some extent.  (This still doesn't solve the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% accented characters problem.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`@=11
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\txisetlanguage#1#2#3{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % do not set the language if the name is undefined in the current TeX.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\ifx\csname lang@#1\endcsname \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \message{no patterns for #1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\language = \csname lang@#1\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % but there is no harm in adjusting the hyphenmin values regardless.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\lefthyphenmin = #2\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\righthyphenmin = #3\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% XeTeX and LuaTeX can handle Unicode natively.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Their default I/O uses UTF-8 sequences instead of a byte-wise operation.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Other TeX engines' I/O (pdfTeX, etc.) is byte-wise.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\iftxinativeunicodecapable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\iftxiusebytewiseio
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \txinativeunicodecapablefalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \txiusebytewiseiotrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \txinativeunicodecapabletrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \txiusebytewiseiofalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \txinativeunicodecapabletrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \txiusebytewiseiofalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Set I/O by bytes instead of UTF-8 sequence for XeTeX and LuaTex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% for non-UTF-8 (byte-wise) encodings.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setbytewiseio{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \XeTeXdefaultencoding "bytes"  % For subsequent files to be read
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \XeTeXinputencoding "bytes"  % For document root file
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Unfortunately, there seems to be no corresponding XeTeX command for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % output encoding.  This is a problem for auxiliary index and TOC files.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % The only solution would be perhaps to write out @U{...} sequences in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % place of non-ASCII characters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \directlua{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    local utf8_char, byte, gsub = unicode.utf8.char, string.byte, string.gsub
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    local function convert_char (char)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return utf8_char(byte(char))
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    local function convert_line (line)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return gsub(line, ".", convert_char)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    callback.register("process_input_buffer", convert_line)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    local function convert_line_out (line)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      local line_out = ""
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      for c in string.utfvalues(line) do
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								         line_out = line_out .. string.char(c)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      return line_out
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    end
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    callback.register("process_output_buffer", convert_line_out)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \txiusebytewiseiotrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Helpers for encodings.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \count255=128
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \loop\ifnum\count255<256
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance\count255 by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \repeat
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \count255=128
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \loop\ifnum\count255<256
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \catcode\count255=#1\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \advance\count255 by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \repeat
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% according to the specified encoding.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\documentencoding{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\documentencodingzzz}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\documentencodingzzz#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Encoding being declared for the document.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % to compare them with \ifx.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \asciichardefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \iftxinativeunicodecapable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \setbytewiseio
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \lattwochardefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \iftxinativeunicodecapable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \setbytewiseio
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \latonechardefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \iftxinativeunicodecapable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \setbytewiseio
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \latninechardefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \iftxinativeunicodecapable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \nativeunicodechardefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % For treating UTF-8 as byte sequences (TeX, eTeX and pdfTeX)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % since we already invoked \utfeightchardefs at the top level
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % (below), do not re-invoke it, otherwise our check for duplicated
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % definitions gets triggered.  Making non-ascii chars active is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       % sufficient.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \message{Ignoring unknown document encoding: #1.}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi % utfeight
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi % latnine
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi % latone
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi % lattwo
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi % ascii
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \message{Warning: XeTeX with non-UTF-8 encodings cannot handle %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        non-ASCII characters in auxiliary files.}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% emacs-page
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the default font encoding (OT1).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing, sorry: #1.}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% macros containing the character definitions.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\setnonasciicharscatcode\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\gdefchar#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \ifpassthroughchars
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     \string#1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								     #2%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\latonechardefs{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a0{\tie}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a1{\exclamdown}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a2{{\tcfont \char162}} % cent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a3{\pounds{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a4{{\tcfont \char164}} % currency
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a5{{\tcfont \char165}} % yen
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a6{{\tcfont \char166}} % broken bar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a7{\S}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a8{\"{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a9{\copyright{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^aa{\ordf}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ab{\guillemetleft{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ac{\ensuremath\lnot}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ad{\-}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ae{\registeredsymbol{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^af{\={}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b0{\textdegree}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b1{$\pm$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b2{$^2$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b3{$^3$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b4{\'{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b5{$\mu$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b6{\P}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b7{\ensuremath\cdot}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b8{\cedilla\ }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b9{$^1$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ba{\ordm}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^bb{\guillemetright{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^bc{$1\over4$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^bd{$1\over2$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^be{$3\over4$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^bf{\questiondown}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c0{\`A}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c1{\'A}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c2{\^A}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c3{\~A}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c4{\"A}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c5{\ringaccent A}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c6{\AE}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c7{\cedilla C}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c8{\`E}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c9{\'E}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ca{\^E}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^cb{\"E}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^cc{\`I}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^cd{\'I}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ce{\^I}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^cf{\"I}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d0{\DH}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d1{\~N}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d2{\`O}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d3{\'O}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d4{\^O}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d5{\~O}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d6{\"O}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d7{$\times$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d8{\O}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d9{\`U}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^da{\'U}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^db{\^U}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^dc{\"U}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^dd{\'Y}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^de{\TH}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^df{\ss}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e0{\`a}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e1{\'a}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e2{\^a}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e3{\~a}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e4{\"a}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e5{\ringaccent a}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e6{\ae}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e7{\cedilla c}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e8{\`e}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e9{\'e}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ea{\^e}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^eb{\"e}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ec{\`{\dotless i}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ed{\'{\dotless i}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ee{\^{\dotless i}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ef{\"{\dotless i}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f0{\dh}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f1{\~n}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f2{\`o}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f3{\'o}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f4{\^o}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f5{\~o}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f6{\"o}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f7{$\div$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f8{\o}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f9{\`u}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^fa{\'u}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^fb{\^u}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^fc{\"u}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^fd{\'y}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^fe{\th}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ff{\"y}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\latninechardefs{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \latonechardefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a4{\euro{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a6{\v S}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a8{\v s}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b4{\v Z}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b8{\v z}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^bc{\OE}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^bd{\oe}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^be{\"Y}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\lattwochardefs{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a0{\tie}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a1{\ogonek{A}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a2{\u{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a3{\L}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a5{\v L}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a6{\'S}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a7{\S}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a8{\"{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^a9{\v S}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^aa{\cedilla S}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ab{\v T}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ac{\'Z}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ad{\-}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ae{\v Z}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^af{\dotaccent Z}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b0{\textdegree{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b1{\ogonek{a}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b2{\ogonek{ }}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b3{\l}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b4{\'{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b5{\v l}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b6{\'s}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b7{\v{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b8{\cedilla\ }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^b9{\v s}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ba{\cedilla s}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^bb{\v t}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^bc{\'z}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^bd{\H{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^be{\v z}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^bf{\dotaccent z}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c0{\'R}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c1{\'A}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c2{\^A}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c3{\u A}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c4{\"A}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c5{\'L}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c6{\'C}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c7{\cedilla C}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c8{\v C}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^c9{\'E}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ca{\ogonek{E}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^cb{\"E}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^cc{\v E}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^cd{\'I}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ce{\^I}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^cf{\v D}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d0{\DH}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d1{\'N}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d2{\v N}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d3{\'O}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d4{\^O}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d5{\H O}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d6{\"O}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d7{$\times$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d8{\v R}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^d9{\ringaccent U}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^da{\'U}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^db{\H U}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^dc{\"U}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^dd{\'Y}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^de{\cedilla T}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^df{\ss}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e0{\'r}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e1{\'a}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e2{\^a}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e3{\u a}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e4{\"a}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e5{\'l}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e6{\'c}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e7{\cedilla c}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e8{\v c}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^e9{\'e}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ea{\ogonek{e}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^eb{\"e}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ec{\v e}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ed{\'{\dotless{i}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ee{\^{\dotless{i}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ef{\v d}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f0{\dh}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f1{\'n}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f2{\v n}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f3{\'o}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f4{\^o}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f5{\H o}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f6{\"o}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f7{$\div$}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f8{\v r}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^f9{\ringaccent u}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^fa{\'u}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^fb{\H u}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^fc{\"u}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^fd{\'y}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^fe{\cedilla t}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdefchar^^ff{\dotaccent{}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% UTF-8 character definitions.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% changes for Texinfo conventions.  It is included here under the GPL by
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\countUTFx
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\countUTFy
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newcount\countUTFz
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx #1\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter #1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Give non-ASCII bytes the active definitions for processing UTF-8 sequences
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\~13
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\$12
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\"12
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Loop from \countUTFx to \countUTFy, performing \UTFviiiTmp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % substituting ~ and $ with a character token of that value.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\UTFviiiLoop{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \uccode`\~\countUTFx
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \uccode`\$\countUTFx
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\countUTFx by 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % For bytes other than the first in a UTF-8 sequence.  Not expected to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % be expanded except when writing to auxiliary files.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \countUTFx = "80
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \countUTFy = "C2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \gdef~{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifpassthroughchars $\fi}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \UTFviiiLoop
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \countUTFx = "C2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \countUTFy = "E0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \gdef~{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifpassthroughchars $%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \else\expandafter\UTFviiiTwoOctets\expandafter$\fi}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \UTFviiiLoop
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \countUTFx = "E0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \countUTFy = "F0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \gdef~{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifpassthroughchars $%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \else\expandafter\UTFviiiThreeOctets\expandafter$\fi}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \UTFviiiLoop
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \countUTFx = "F0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \countUTFy = "F4
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \gdef~{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifpassthroughchars $%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \else\expandafter\UTFviiiFourOctets\expandafter$\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        }}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \UTFviiiLoop
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\globallet{\global\let} % save some \expandafter's below
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @U{xxxx} to produce U+xxxx, if we support it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\U#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:#1\endcsname \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \iftxinativeunicodecapable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % All Unicode characters can be used if native Unicode handling is
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % active.  However, if the font does not have the glyph,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % letters are missing.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \uccode`\.="#1\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \uppercase{.}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \errhelp = \EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \errmessage{Unicode character U+#1 not supported, sorry}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \csname uni:#1\endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% These macros are used here to construct the name of a control
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% sequence to be defined.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\UTFviiiTwoOctetsName#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\UTFviiiThreeOctetsName#1#2#3{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\UTFviiiFourOctetsName#1#2#3#4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For UTF-8 byte sequences (TeX, e-TeX and pdfTeX),
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% provide a definition macro to replace a Unicode character;
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% this gets used by the @U command
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\"=12
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\<=12
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\.=12
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\,=12
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\;=12
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\!=12
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode`\~=13
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacterUTFviii#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \countUTFz = "#1\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \parseXMLCharref
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % Give \u8:... its definition.  The sequence of seven \expandafter's
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % expands after the \gdef three times, e.g.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % 1.  \UTFviiTwoOctetsName B1 B2
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % 2.  \csname u8:B1 \string B2 \endcsname
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % 3.  \u8: B1 B2  (a single control sequence token)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\expandafter
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\gdef       \UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:#1\endcsname \relax \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								       \message{Internal error, already defined: #1}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % define an additional control sequence for this code point.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \expandafter\globallet\csname uni:#1\endcsname \UTFviiiTmp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Given the value in \countUTFz as a Unicode code point, set \UTFviiiTmp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % to the corresponding UTF-8 sequence.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \errhelp = \EMsimple
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \parseUTFviiiA,%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctetsName.,%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \parseUTFviiiA;%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \parseUTFviiiA,%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctetsName.{,;}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \parseUTFviiiA;%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \parseUTFviiiA,%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \parseUTFviiiA!%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctetsName.{!,;}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi\fi\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Extract a byte from the end of the UTF-8 representation of \countUTFx.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % It must be a non-initial byte in the sequence.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Change \uccode of #1 for it to be used in \parseUTFviiiB as one
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % of the bytes.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \countUTFx = \countUTFz
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \divide\countUTFz by 64
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \countUTFy = \countUTFz  % Save to be the future value of \countUTFz.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \multiply\countUTFz by 64
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % \countUTFz is now \countUTFx with the last 5 bits cleared.  Subtract
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % in order to get the last five bits.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Convert this to the byte in the UTF-8 sequence.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\countUTFx by 128
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \uccode `#1\countUTFx
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \countUTFz = \countUTFy}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Used to put a UTF-8 byte sequence into \UTFviiiTmp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % #1 is the increment for \countUTFz to yield a the first byte of the UTF-8
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %    sequence.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % #2 is one of the \UTFviii*OctetsName macros.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % #3 is always a full stop (.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % #4 is a template for the other bytes in the sequence.  The values for these
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %    bytes is substituted in here with \uppercase using the \uccode's.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \uccode `#3\countUTFz
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX),
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% provide a definition macro that sets a catcode to `other' non-globally
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNativeOther#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode"#1=\other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Plane_(Unicode)#Basic_M
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% U+0000..U+007F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Basic_Latin_(Unicode_block)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% U+0080..U+00FF = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin-1_Supplement_(Unicode_block)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% U+0100..U+017F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-A
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% U+0180..U+024F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-B
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Many of our renditions are less than wonderful, and all the missing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% characters are available somewhere.  Loading the necessary fonts
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% awaits user request.  We can't truly support Unicode without
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% reimplementing everything that's been done in LaTeX for many years,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% plus probably using luatex or xetex, and who knows what else.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We won't be doing that here in this simple file.  But we can try to at
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% least make most of the characters not bomb out.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\unicodechardefs{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A2}{{\tcfont \char162}}% 0242=cent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A4}{{\tcfont \char164}}% 0244=currency
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A5}{{\tcfont \char165}}% 0245=yen
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A6}{{\tcfont \char166}}% 0246=brokenbar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A7}{\S}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AC}{\ensuremath\lnot}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B1}{\ensuremath\pm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B2}{$^2$}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B3}{$^3$}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B5}{$\mu$}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B6}{\P}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B7}{\ensuremath\cdot}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B9}{$^1$}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BC}{$1\over4$}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BD}{$1\over2$}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BE}{$3\over4$}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D0}{\DH}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D7}{\ensuremath\times}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DE}{\TH}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F0}{\dh}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F7}{\ensuremath\div}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FE}{\th}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0104}{\ogonek{A}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0105}{\ogonek{a}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010F}{d'}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0110}{\DH}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0111}{\dh}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0118}{\ogonek{E}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0119}{\ogonek{e}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0122}{\cedilla{G}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0123}{\cedilla{g}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0126}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0127}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012E}{\ogonek{I}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012F}{\ogonek{i}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0136}{\cedilla{K}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0137}{\cedilla{k}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0138}{\ensuremath\kappa}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013B}{\cedilla{L}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013C}{\cedilla{l}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013D}{L'}% should kern
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013E}{l'}% should kern
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013F}{L\U{00B7}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0140}{l\U{00B7}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0145}{\cedilla{N}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0146}{\cedilla{n}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0149}{'n}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014A}{\missingcharmsg{ENG}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014B}{\missingcharmsg{eng}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0156}{\cedilla{R}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0157}{\cedilla{r}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{T}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{t}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0165}{\v{t}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0166}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0167}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0172}{\ogonek{U}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0173}{\ogonek{u}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017F}{\missingcharmsg{LONG S}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02BC}{'}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02DB}{\ogonek{ }}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Greek letters upper case
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0391}{{\it A}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0392}{{\it B}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0393}{\ensuremath{\mit\Gamma}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0394}{\ensuremath{\mit\Delta}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0395}{{\it E}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0396}{{\it Z}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0397}{{\it H}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0398}{\ensuremath{\mit\Theta}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0399}{{\it I}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039A}{{\it K}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039B}{\ensuremath{\mit\Lambda}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039C}{{\it M}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039D}{{\it N}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039E}{\ensuremath{\mit\Xi}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039F}{{\it O}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A0}{\ensuremath{\mit\Pi}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A1}{{\it P}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A2}{} % none - corresponds to final sigma
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A3}{\ensuremath{\mit\Sigma}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A4}{{\it T}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A5}{\ensuremath{\mit\Upsilon}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A6}{\ensuremath{\mit\Phi}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A7}{{\it X}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A8}{\ensuremath{\mit\Psi}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A9}{\ensuremath{\mit\Omega}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Vowels with accents
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0390}{\ensuremath{\ddot{\acute\iota}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AC}{\ensuremath{\acute\alpha}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AD}{\ensuremath{\acute\epsilon}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AE}{\ensuremath{\acute\eta}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AF}{\ensuremath{\acute\iota}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B0}{\ensuremath{\acute{\ddot\upsilon}}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Standalone accent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0384}{\ensuremath{\acute{\ }}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Greek letters lower case
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B1}{\ensuremath\alpha}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B2}{\ensuremath\beta}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B3}{\ensuremath\gamma}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B4}{\ensuremath\delta}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B5}{\ensuremath\epsilon}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B6}{\ensuremath\zeta}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B7}{\ensuremath\eta}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B8}{\ensuremath\theta}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B9}{\ensuremath\iota}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BA}{\ensuremath\kappa}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BB}{\ensuremath\lambda}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BC}{\ensuremath\mu}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BD}{\ensuremath\nu}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BE}{\ensuremath\xi}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BF}{{\it o}}% omicron
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C0}{\ensuremath\pi}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C1}{\ensuremath\rho}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C2}{\ensuremath\varsigma}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C3}{\ensuremath\sigma}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C4}{\ensuremath\tau}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C5}{\ensuremath\upsilon}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C6}{\ensuremath\phi}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C7}{\ensuremath\chi}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C8}{\ensuremath\psi}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C9}{\ensuremath\omega}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % More Greek vowels with accents
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CA}{\ensuremath{\ddot\iota}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CB}{\ensuremath{\ddot\upsilon}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CC}{\ensuremath{\acute o}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CD}{\ensuremath{\acute\upsilon}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CE}{\ensuremath{\acute\omega}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Variant Greek letters
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03D1}{\ensuremath\vartheta}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03D6}{\ensuremath\varpi}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03F1}{\ensuremath\varrho}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Punctuation
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2020}{\ensuremath\dagger}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2021}{\ensuremath\ddagger}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{202F}{\thinspace}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Mathematical symbols
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2200}{\ensuremath\forall}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2203}{\ensuremath\exists}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2208}{\ensuremath\in}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\ast}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221E}{\ensuremath\infty}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2225}{\ensuremath\parallel}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2227}{\ensuremath\wedge}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2229}{\ensuremath\cap}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv{}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2264}{\ensuremath\leq}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2265}{\ensuremath\geq}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2282}{\ensuremath\subset}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2287}{\ensuremath\supseteq}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2016}{\ensuremath\Vert}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2032}{\ensuremath\prime}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{210F}{\ensuremath\hbar}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2111}{\ensuremath\Im}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2113}{\ensuremath\ell}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2118}{\ensuremath\wp}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{211C}{\ensuremath\Re}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2135}{\ensuremath\aleph}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2190}{\ensuremath\leftarrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2191}{\ensuremath\uparrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2193}{\ensuremath\downarrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2194}{\ensuremath\leftrightarrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2195}{\ensuremath\updownarrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2196}{\ensuremath\nwarrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2197}{\ensuremath\nearrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2198}{\ensuremath\searrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2199}{\ensuremath\swarrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21A6}{\ensuremath\mapsto}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21A9}{\ensuremath\hookleftarrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21AA}{\ensuremath\hookrightarrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BC}{\ensuremath\leftharpoonup}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BD}{\ensuremath\leftharpoondown}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21C0}{\ensuremath\rightharpoonup}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21C1}{\ensuremath\rightharpoondown}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21CC}{\ensuremath\rightleftharpoons}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D0}{\ensuremath\Leftarrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D1}{\ensuremath\Uparrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D3}{\ensuremath\Downarrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D4}{\ensuremath\Leftrightarrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D5}{\ensuremath\Updownarrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2202}{\ensuremath\partial}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2205}{\ensuremath\emptyset}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2207}{\ensuremath\nabla}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2209}{\ensuremath\notin}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{220B}{\ensuremath\owns}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{220F}{\ensuremath\prod}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2210}{\ensuremath\coprod}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2211}{\ensuremath\sum}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2213}{\ensuremath\mp}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2218}{\ensuremath\circ}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221A}{\ensuremath\surd}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221D}{\ensuremath\propto}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2220}{\ensuremath\angle}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2223}{\ensuremath\mid}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2228}{\ensuremath\vee}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222A}{\ensuremath\cup}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222B}{\ensuremath\smallint}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222E}{\ensuremath\oint}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{223C}{\ensuremath\sim}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2240}{\ensuremath\wr}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2243}{\ensuremath\simeq}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2245}{\ensuremath\cong}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2248}{\ensuremath\approx}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{224D}{\ensuremath\asymp}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2250}{\ensuremath\doteq}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2260}{\ensuremath\neq}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{226A}{\ensuremath\ll}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{226B}{\ensuremath\gg}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{227A}{\ensuremath\prec}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{227B}{\ensuremath\succ}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2283}{\ensuremath\supset}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2286}{\ensuremath\subseteq}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{228E}{\ensuremath\uplus}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2291}{\ensuremath\sqsubseteq}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2292}{\ensuremath\sqsupseteq}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2293}{\ensuremath\sqcap}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2294}{\ensuremath\sqcup}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2295}{\ensuremath\oplus}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2296}{\ensuremath\ominus}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2297}{\ensuremath\otimes}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2298}{\ensuremath\oslash}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2299}{\ensuremath\odot}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A2}{\ensuremath\vdash}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A3}{\ensuremath\dashv}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A4}{\ensuremath\ptextop}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A5}{\ensuremath\bot}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A8}{\ensuremath\models}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C0}{\ensuremath\bigwedge}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C1}{\ensuremath\bigvee}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C2}{\ensuremath\bigcap}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C3}{\ensuremath\bigcup}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C4}{\ensuremath\diamond}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C5}{\ensuremath\cdot}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C6}{\ensuremath\star}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C8}{\ensuremath\bowtie}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2308}{\ensuremath\lceil}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2309}{\ensuremath\rceil}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{230A}{\ensuremath\lfloor}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{230B}{\ensuremath\rfloor}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2322}{\ensuremath\frown}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2323}{\ensuremath\smile}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25B3}{\ensuremath\triangle}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25B7}{\ensuremath\triangleright}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25BD}{\ensuremath\bigtriangledown}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25C1}{\ensuremath\triangleleft}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25C7}{\ensuremath\diamond}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2660}{\ensuremath\spadesuit}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2661}{\ensuremath\heartsuit}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2662}{\ensuremath\diamondsuit}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2663}{\ensuremath\clubsuit}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266D}{\ensuremath\flat}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266E}{\ensuremath\natural}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266F}{\ensuremath\sharp}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{26AA}{\ensuremath\bigcirc}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27B9}{\ensuremath\rangle}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27C2}{\ensuremath\perp}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27E8}{\ensuremath\langle}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F5}{\ensuremath\longleftarrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F6}{\ensuremath\longrightarrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F7}{\ensuremath\longleftrightarrow}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27FC}{\ensuremath\longmapsto}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{29F5}{\ensuremath\setminus}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A00}{\ensuremath\bigodot}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A01}{\ensuremath\bigoplus}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A02}{\ensuremath\bigotimes}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A04}{\ensuremath\biguplus}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A06}{\ensuremath\bigsqcup}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A3F}{\ensuremath\amalg}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2AAF}{\ensuremath\preceq}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2AB0}{\ensuremath\succeq}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \global\mathchardef\checkmark="1370% actually the square root sign
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2713}{\ensuremath\checkmark}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}% end of \unicodechardefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% UTF-8 byte sequence (pdfTeX) definitions (replacing and @U command)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% It makes the setting that replace UTF-8 byte sequence.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\utfeightchardefs{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\DeclareUnicodeCharacter\DeclareUnicodeCharacterUTFviii
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \unicodechardefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Whether the active definitions of non-ASCII characters expand to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% non-active tokens with the same character code.  This is used to
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% write characters literally, instead of using active definitions for
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% printing the correct glyphs.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newif\ifpassthroughchars
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\passthroughcharsfalse
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX),
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% provide a definition macro to replace/pass-through a Unicode character
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNative#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \catcode"#1=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\dodeclareunicodecharacternative##1##2##3{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \uccode`\~="##2\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \uppercase{\gdef~}{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \ifpassthroughchars
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ##1%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								          ##3%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								        \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \begingroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \uccode`\.="#1\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \uppercase{\def\UTFNativeTmp{.}}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \expandafter\dodeclareunicodecharacternative\UTFNativeTmp{#1}{#2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \endgroup
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX) character replacing definition.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% It activates the setting that replaces Unicode characters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\nativeunicodechardefs{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\DeclareUnicodeCharacter\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNative
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \unicodechardefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX),
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% make the character token expand
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% to the sequences given in \unicodechardefs for printing.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNativeAtU#1#2{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \def\UTFAtUTmp{#2}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \expandafter\globallet\csname uni:#1\endcsname \UTFAtUTmp
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @U command definitions for native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\nativeunicodechardefsatu{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\DeclareUnicodeCharacter\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNativeAtU
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \unicodechardefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% US-ASCII character definitions.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   \relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define all Unicode characters we know about.  This makes UTF-8 the default
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% input encoding and allows @U to work.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\iftxinativeunicodecapable
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \nativeunicodechardefsatu
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \utfeightchardefs
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{formatting,}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\vbadness = 10000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Don't be very finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\hbadness = 6666
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\widowpenalty=10000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\clubpenalty=10000
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.  We want the amount of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \hsize.  We call this whenever the paper size is set.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\setemergencystretch{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \emergencystretch = .15\hsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \textleading.  The caller should also set \parskip.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \voffset = #3\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \topskip = #6\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \splittopskip = \topskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \vsize = #1\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\vsize by \topskip
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \outervsize = \vsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \txipageheight = \vsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \hsize = #2\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \outerhsize = \hsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \txipagewidth = \hsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \normaloffset = #4\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \bindingoffset = #5\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \ifpdf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \pdfpageheight #7\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \pdfhorigin = 1 true in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \pdfvorigin = 1 true in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \special{papersize=#8,#7}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \else
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \pdfpageheight #7\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								      % XeTeX does not have \pdfhorigin and \pdfvorigin.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setleading{\textleading}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parindent = \defaultparindent
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setemergencystretch
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @letterpaper (the default).
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \textleading = 13.2pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {\voffset}{.25in}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {11in}{8.5in}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \textleading = 12pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {-.2in}{0in}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {9.25in}{7in}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \lispnarrowing = 0.3in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tolerance = 700
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \defbodyindent = .5cm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \textleading = 12pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {-.2in}{-.4in}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {0pt}{14pt}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {9in}{6in}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \lispnarrowing = 0.25in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tolerance = 700
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \defbodyindent = .4cm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \textleading = 13.2pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align.  Then
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % do the same for \bindingoffset.  You can set these for testing in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % your texinfo source file like this:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % @tex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % @end tex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {297mm}{210mm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tolerance = 700
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \defbodyindent = 5mm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \textleading = 12.5pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {\bindingoffset}{8pt}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {210mm}{148mm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tolerance = 800
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \defbodyindent = 2mm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \tableindent = 12mm
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \afourpaper
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {\voffset}{4.6mm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {297mm}{210mm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \globaldefs = 0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \afourpaper
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {\voffset}{-2.95mm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {297mm}{210mm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \globaldefs = 0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\bsixpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \afourpaper
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \internalpagesizes{140mm}{100mm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {-6.35mm}{-12.7mm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {\bindingoffset}{14pt}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {176mm}{125mm}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\SETdispenvsize=\smallword
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \globaldefs = 0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \globaldefs = 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \setleading{\textleading}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dimen0 = #1\relax
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\dimen0 by 2.5in % default 1in margin above heading line
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                           % and 1.5in to include heading, footing and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                           % bottom margin
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \dimen2 = \hsize
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \advance\dimen2 by 2in % default to 1 inch margin on each side
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								                    {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Set default to letter.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\letterpaper
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Default value of \hfuzz, for suppressing warnings about overfull hboxes.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\hfuzz = 1pt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def^^L{\par} % remove \outer, so ^L can appear in an @comment
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% DEL is a comment character, in case @c does not suffice.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\^^? = 14
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\"=\other \def\normaldoublequote{"}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\$=\other \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\+=\other \def\normalplus{+}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\<=\other \def\normalless{<}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\>=\other \def\normalgreater{>}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\^=\other \def\normalcaret{^}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\_=\other \def\normalunderscore{_}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\|=\other \def\normalverticalbar{|}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\~=\other \def\normaltilde{~}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% where something hairier probably needs to be done.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% otherwise.  Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Same as above, but check for italic font.  Actually this also catches
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% italic fonts.  But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% this is not a problem.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Set catcodes for Texinfo file
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Active characters for printing the wanted glyph.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\"=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let"=\activedoublequote
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\~=\active \def\activetilde{{\tt\char126}} \let~ = \activetilde
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\chardef\hatchar=`\^
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\^=\active \def\activehat{{\tt \hatchar}} \let^ = \activehat
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\_=\active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\let\realunder=_
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\|=\active \def|{{\tt\char124}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\chardef \less=`\<
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\<=\active \def\activeless{{\tt \less}}\let< = \activeless
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\chardef \gtr=`\>
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\>=\active \def\activegtr{{\tt \gtr}}\let> = \activegtr
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\+=\active \def+{{\tt \char 43}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\$=\active \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\-=\active \let-=\normaldash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% used for headline/footline in the output routine, in case the page
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% breaks in the middle of an @tex block.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\texinfochars{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let< = \activeless
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let> = \activegtr
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let~ = \activetilde
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let^ = \activehat
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \markupsetuplqdefault \markupsetuprqdefault
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\b = \strong
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \let\i = \smartitalic
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % in principle, all other definitions in \tex have to be undone too.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% parsing them.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\def\turnoffactive{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \normalturnoffactive
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  \otherbackslash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\@=0
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% as in \char`\\.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% In Texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% in fixed width font.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								\catcode`\\=\active  % @ for escape char from now on.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Print a typewriter backslash.  For math mode, we can't simply use
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \backslashcurfont: the story here is that in math mode, the \char
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% of \backslashcurfont ends up printing the roman \ from the math symbol
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% font (because \char in math mode uses the \mathcode, and plain.tex
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% sets \mathcode`\\="026E).  Hence we use an explicit \mathchar,
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% which is the decimal equivalent of "715c (class 7, e.g., use \fam;
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% ignored family value; char position "5C).  We can't use " for the
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% usual hex value because it has already been made active.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@def@ttbackslash{{@tt @ifmmode @mathchar29020 @else @backslashcurfont @fi}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@let@backslashchar = @ttbackslash % @backslashchar{} is for user documents.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% catcode other.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the literal character `\'.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{@catcode`- = @active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								 @gdef@normalturnoffactive{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @passthroughcharstrue
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @let-=@normaldash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @let"=@normaldoublequote
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @let+=@normalplus
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @let<=@normalless
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @let>=@normalgreater
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @let^=@normalcaret
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @let_=@normalunderscore
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @let|=@normalverticalbar
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @let~=@normaltilde
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @let\=@ttbackslash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @markupsetuplqdefault
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @markupsetuprqdefault
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								   @unsepspaces
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								 }
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% So turn them off again, and have @fixbackslash turn them back on.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@catcode`+=@other @catcode`@_=@other
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% \enablebackslashhack - allow file to begin `\input texinfo'
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% a backslash.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% If the file did not have a `\input texinfo', then it is turned off after
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% the first line; otherwise the first `\' in the file would cause an error.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% This is used on the very last line of this file, texinfo.tex.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% We also use @c to call @fixbackslash, in case ends of lines are hidden.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@catcode`@^=7
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@catcode`@^^M=13@gdef@enablebackslashhack{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @global@let\ = @eatinput%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @catcode`@^^M=13%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @def@c{@fixbackslash@c}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Definition for the newline at the end of this file.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @def ^^M{@let^^M@secondlinenl}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Definition for a newline in the main Texinfo file.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @gdef @secondlinenl{@fixbackslash}%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % In case the first line has a whole-line command on it
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @let@originalparsearg@parsearg
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @def@parsearg{@fixbackslash@originalparsearg}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{@catcode`@^=7 @catcode`@^^M=13%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@gdef@eatinput input texinfo#1^^M{@fixbackslash}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Emergency active definition of newline, in case an active newline token
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% appears by mistake.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								{@catcode`@^=7 @catcode13=13%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@gdef@enableemergencynewline{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @gdef^^M{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    @par%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								    %<warning: active newline>@par%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}}}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@gdef@fixbackslash{%
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @ttbackslash @fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @catcode13=5 % regular end of line
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @enableemergencynewline
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @let@c=@comment
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @let@parsearg@originalparsearg
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @catcode`+=@active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @catcode`@_=@active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.  This macro, @fixbackslash, gets
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % called at the beginning of every Texinfo file.  Not opening texinfo.cnf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % directly in this file, texinfo.tex, makes it possible to make a format
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  % file for Texinfo.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  %
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @openin 1 texinfo.cnf
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @ifeof 1 @else @input texinfo.cnf @fi
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								  @closein 1
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@escapechar = `@@
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% These (along with & and #) are made active for url-breaking, so need
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% active definitions as the normal characters.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@def@normaldot{.}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@def@normalquest{?}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@def@normalslash{/}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								% @hashchar{} gets its own user-level command, because of #line.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@catcode`@& = @other @def@normalamp{&}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@catcode`@# = @other @def@normalhash{#}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@catcode`@% = @other @def@normalpercent{%}
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@let @hashchar = @normalhash
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@c Finally, make ` and ' active, so that txicodequoteundirected and
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@c txicodequotebacktick work right in, e.g., @w{@code{`foo'}}.  If we
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@c don't make ` and ' active, @code will not get them as active chars.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@c Do this last of all since we use ` in the previous @catcode assignments.
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@catcode`@'=@active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@catcode`@`=@active
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@markupsetuplqdefault
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@markupsetuprqdefault
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@c Local variables:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@c eval: (add-hook 'before-save-hook 'time-stamp)
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message\\|emacs-page"
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{"
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@c time-stamp-end: "}"
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@c End:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@c vim:sw=2:
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								
							 | 
						|||
| 
								 | 
							
								@enablebackslashhack
							 |